]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi
710f674860aeba0af4153277d49f8c09526272f2
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * D Language and ABI:: Controlling D ABI changes.
56 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
57 * Misc:: Everything else.
58 @end menu
59
60 @node Target Structure
61 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
62 @cindex target hooks
63 @cindex target functions
64
65 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
66 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
67 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
68 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
69 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
70 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
71 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
72 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
73 @smallexample
74 #include "target.h"
75 #include "target-def.h"
76
77 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
78
79 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
80 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
81
82 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
83 @end smallexample
84 @end deftypevar
85
86 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
87 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
88 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
89 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
90 @code{targetm} structure.
91
92 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
93 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
94 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
95 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
96 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
97 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
98 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
99
100 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
101 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
102 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
103 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
104 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
105 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
106 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
107 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
108 default definition is used.
109
110 Similarly, there is a @code{targetdm} variable for hooks that are
111 specific to the D language front end, documented as ``D Target Hook''.
112 This is declared in @file{d/d-target.h}, the initializer
113 @code{TARGETDM_INITIALIZER} in @file{d/d-target-def.h}. If targets
114 initialize @code{targetdm} themselves, they should set
115 @code{target_has_targetdm=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default
116 definition is used.
117
118 @node Driver
119 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
120 @cindex driver
121 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
122
123 @c prevent bad page break with this line
124 You can control the compilation driver.
125
126 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
127 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
128 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
129
130 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
131 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
132 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
133 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
134 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
135 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
136
137 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
138 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
139 that the other specs are easier to write.
140
141 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
142 @end defmac
143
144 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
145 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
146 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
147 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
148 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
149
150 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
151 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
152 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
153 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
154 everywhere it occurs.
155
156 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
157 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
158 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CPP_SPEC
164 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
166 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
167
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
172 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
173 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
174 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
175 @end defmac
176
177 @defmac CC1_SPEC
178 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
179 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
180 front ends.
181 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
182 for GCC to pass to front ends.
183
184 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
185 @end defmac
186
187 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
188 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
189 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
190 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
191
192 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
193 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
194 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
195 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
200 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
201 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
202 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
208 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
209 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
210 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
211 an example of this.
212
213 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
214 @end defmac
215
216 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
217 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
218 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
219 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
220 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
221 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
222
223 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
224 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
225 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
226 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
227 @end defmac
228
229 @defmac LINK_SPEC
230 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
231 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
232 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
233
234 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIB_SPEC
238 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
239 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
240 command given to the linker.
241
242 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
243 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
244 @end defmac
245
246 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
247 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
248 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
249 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
250 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
251
252 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
253 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
254 @end defmac
255
256 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
257 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
258 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
259 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
260 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
261 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
262 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
263 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
264 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
265 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
269 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
270 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
271 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
272 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
273 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
274 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
278 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
279 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
280 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
281 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
288
289 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
290 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
291 @end defmac
292
293 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
294 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
295 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
296 the very end of the command given to the linker.
297
298 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
299 @end defmac
300
301 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
302 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
303 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
304 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
305 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
306 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
307 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
308 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
309 @end defmac
310
311 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
312 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
313 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
314 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
318 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
319 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
320 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
321 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
322 @end defmac
323
324 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
325 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
326 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
327 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
328
329 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
330 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
331 string constant that provides the specification.
332
333 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
334
335 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
336 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
337 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
338 these definitions.
339
340 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
341 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
342 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
343 used.
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
346
347 @smallexample
348 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
349 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
350
351 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
352 @end smallexample
353
354 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
355 @smallexample
356 #undef CPP_SPEC
357 #define CPP_SPEC \
358 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
359 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
360 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
361 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
362
363 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
364 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
365 @end smallexample
366
367 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
368 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
369
370 @smallexample
371 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
372 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
373 @end smallexample
374 @end defmac
375
376 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
377 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
378 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
379 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
380 @end defmac
381
382 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
383 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
384 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
385 @end defmac
386
387 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
388 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
389 The default value of this macro is empty string.
390 @end defmac
391
392 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
393 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
394 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
395 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
396 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
397 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
398 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
399 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
400 @end defmac
401
402 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
403 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
404 @end deftypevr
405
406 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
407 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
408 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
409 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
410 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
411
412 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
413 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
414 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
415 @xref{Target Fragment}.
416 @end defmac
417
418 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
419 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
420 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
421 indicates an absolute file name.
422 @end defmac
423
424 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
425 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
426 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
427 when the compiler is built as a cross
428 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
429 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
430 @end defmac
431
432 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
433 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
435 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
437 is built as a cross compiler.
438 @end defmac
439
440 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
441 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
443 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
445 is built as a cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
449 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
450 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
451 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
452 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
453 is built as a cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
457 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
458 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
459 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
460 @end defmac
461
462 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
463 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
464 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
465 cross compiler.
466 @end defmac
467
468 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
469 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
470 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
471 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
472 initialize the necessary environment variables.
473 @end defmac
474
475 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
476 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
477 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
478 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
479 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
480 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
481
482 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
483 replacement.
484 @end defmac
485
486 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
487 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
488 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
489 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
490 @end defmac
491
492 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
493 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
494 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
495 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
496 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
497 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
498 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
499 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
500 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
501
502 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
503 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
504 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
505 for C++-only directories,
506 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
507 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
508 the array with a null element.
509
510 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
511 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
512 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
513 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
514
515 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
516
517 @smallexample
518 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
519 @{ \
520 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
521 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
522 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
523 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
524 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
525 @}
526 @end smallexample
527 @end defmac
528
529 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
530
531 @enumerate
532 @item
533 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
534
535 @item
536 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
537 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
538 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
539
540 @item
541 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
542
543 @item
544 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
545 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
546
547 @item
548 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
549
550 @item
551 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
552
553 @item
554 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
555 compiler.
556 @end enumerate
557
558 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
559
560 @enumerate
561 @item
562 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
563
564 @item
565 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
566 value based on the installed toolchain location.
567
568 @item
569 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
570 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
571
572 @item
573 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
574 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
575
576 @item
577 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
578
579 @item
580 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
581 compiler.
582
583 @item
584 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
585 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
589 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
593 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
594 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
595
596 @item
597 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
598 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
599 @file{/lib/}.
600
601 @item
602 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
603 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
604 @file{/usr/lib/}.
605 @end enumerate
606
607 @node Run-time Target
608 @section Run-time Target Specification
609 @cindex run-time target specification
610 @cindex predefined macros
611 @cindex target specifications
612
613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
614 Here are run-time target specifications.
615
616 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
617 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
618 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
619 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
620 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
621 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
622 finished command line option processing your code can use those
623 results freely.
624
625 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
626 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
627 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
628 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
629
630 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
631 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
632 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
633 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
634 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
635 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
636 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
637 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
638 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
639 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
640
641 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
642 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
643 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
644 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
645 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
646 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
647 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
648 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
649 preprocessing.
650 @end defmac
651
652 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
653 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
654 and is used for the target operating system instead.
655 @end defmac
656
657 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
658 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
659 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
660 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
661 it yourself.
662 @end defmac
663
664 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
665 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
666 any target-specific headers.
667 @end deftypevar
668
669 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
670 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
671 Its default setting is 0.
672 @end deftypevr
673
674 @cindex optional hardware or system features
675 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
676
677 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
678 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
680 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
681 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
682 definition does nothing but return true.
683
684 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
685 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
686 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
687 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
688 via attributes).
689 @end deftypefn
690
691 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
692 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
693 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
694 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
695 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
696 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
697 default definition does nothing but return false.
698
699 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
700 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
701 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
702 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
703 @end deftypefn
704
705 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
706 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
707 @end deftypefn
708
709 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
710 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
711 @end deftypefn
712
713 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
714 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
715 @end deftypefn
716
717 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
718 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
719 @end deftypefn
720
721 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
722 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
723 @end deftypefn
724
725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
726 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
727 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
728 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
729 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
730 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
731 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
732 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
733 @end deftypefn
734
735 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
736 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
737 but is only used in the C
738 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
739 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
740 frontends.
741 @end defmac
742
743 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
744 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
745 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
746 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
747 options are processed once
748 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
749 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
750 options passed explicitly.
751
752 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
753 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
754 @code{optimize} attribute.
755 @end deftypevr
756
757 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
758 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
759 @end deftypefn
760
761 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
762 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
763 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
764 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
765 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
766 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
767
768 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
769 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
770 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
771 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
772 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
773 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
774 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
775
776 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
777 is 0.
778 @end defmac
779
780 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
781 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
782 @end deftypefn
783
784 @node Per-Function Data
785 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
786 @cindex per-function data
787 @cindex data structures
788
789 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
790 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
791 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
792 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
793 when another one comes along.
794
795 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
796 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
797 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
798 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
799 to their own specific data.
800
801 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
802 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
803 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
804 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
805
806 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
807 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
808 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
809 function, for level 0.
810
811 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
812 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
813 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
814 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
815 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
816 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
817 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
818 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
819 longer supported.
820
821 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
822 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
823 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
824 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
825 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
826 @end defmac
827
828 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
829 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
830 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
831 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
832 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
833 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
834
835 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
836 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
837 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
838 @end deftypevar
839
840 @node Storage Layout
841 @section Storage Layout
842 @cindex storage layout
843
844 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
845 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
846 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
847 @xref{Run-time Target}.
848
849 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
850 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
851 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
852 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
853 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
854 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
855 macro need not be a constant.
856
857 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
858 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
863 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
864 @end defmac
865
866 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
867 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
868 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
869 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
870 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
871 macro need not be a constant.
872 @end defmac
873
874 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
875 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
876 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
877 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
878 the order of words in memory.
879 @end defmac
880
881 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
882 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
883 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
884 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
885 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
886
887 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
888 multi-word integers.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
892 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
893 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
894 @end defmac
895
896 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
897 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
898 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
899 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
904 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
905 @end defmac
906
907 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
908 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
909 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
910 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
911 @end defmac
912
913 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
914 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
915 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
916 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
917 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
918 @end defmac
919
920 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
921 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
922 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
923 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
924 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
925 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
926 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
927
928 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
929 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
930 @end defmac
931
932 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
933 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
934 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
935 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
936 scalar type.
937
938 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
939 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
940 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
941 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
942 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
943 counterparts.
944
945 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
946 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
947 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
948 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
949 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
950 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
951
952 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
953 @end defmac
954
955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
956 Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
957 @end deftypefn
958
959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
960 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
961 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
962 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
963 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
964 pointer} types.
965
966 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
967 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
968 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
969 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
970 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
971 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
972 the signedness may be different.
973
974 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
975
976 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
977 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
978 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
979 @end deftypefn
980
981 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
982 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
983 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
984 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
985 size of an integer.
986 @end defmac
987
988 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
989 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
990 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
991 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
992 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
993 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
994 @end defmac
995
996 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
997 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
998 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
999 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1000 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1001 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1002 @end defmac
1003
1004 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1005 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1006 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1007 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1008 @end defmac
1009
1010 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1011 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1012 @end defmac
1013
1014 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1015 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1016 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1017 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1018 @end defmac
1019
1020 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1021 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1022 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1023 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1024 @end deftypevr
1025
1026 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1027 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1028 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1029 @end defmac
1030
1031 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1032 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1033 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1034 @end defmac
1035
1036 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1037 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1038 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1039 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1040 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1041 @end defmac
1042
1043 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1044 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1045 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1046 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1047 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1048 @end defmac
1049
1050 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed})
1051 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of
1052 type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including
1053 applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1054 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1055 field alignment has not been set by the
1056 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. Note that @var{field}
1057 may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment
1058 of a field of type @var{type} in structure context.
1059 @end defmac
1060
1061 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1062 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1063 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1064
1065 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1066
1067 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1068 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1069 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1070 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1071 @end defmac
1072
1073 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1074 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1075 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1076 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct for functions and
1077 objects with static storage duration. The alignment of automatic
1078 objects may exceed the object file format maximum up to the maximum
1079 supported by GCC. If not defined, the default value is
1080 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1081
1082 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1083 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1084 a 32-bit host e.g.@: @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1085 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1086 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1087 @end defmac
1088
1089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STATIC_RTX_ALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode})
1090 This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for a
1091 statically-allocated rtx, such as a constant pool entry. @var{mode}
1092 is the mode of the rtx. The default implementation returns
1093 @samp{GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
1094 @end deftypefn
1095
1096 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1097 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1098 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1099 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1100 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1101
1102 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103
1104 @findex strcpy
1105 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1106 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1107 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1108 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1109 @end defmac
1110
1111 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1112 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1113 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1114 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1115 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1116
1117 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1118 @end defmac
1119
1120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{constant}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{basic_align})
1121 This hook returns the alignment in bits of a constant that is being
1122 placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and @var{basic_align}
1123 is the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.
1124
1125 The default definition just returns @var{basic_align}.
1126
1127 The typical use of this hook is to increase alignment for string
1128 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1129 constants can be done inline. The function
1130 @code{constant_alignment_word_strings} provides such a definition.
1131 @end deftypefn
1132
1133 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1134 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1135 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1136 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1137 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1138
1139 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1140
1141 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1142 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1143
1144 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1145 @end defmac
1146
1147 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1148 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1149 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1150 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1151 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1152 the vector element type.
1153 @end deftypefn
1154
1155 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1156 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1157 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1158 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1159 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1160 align the slot.
1161
1162 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1163 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1164 be used.
1165
1166 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1167 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1168
1169 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1173 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1174 variable @var{decl}.
1175
1176 If this macro is not defined, then
1177 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1178 is used.
1179
1180 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1181 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1182
1183 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1184 @end defmac
1185
1186 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1187 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1188 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1189 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1190
1191 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1192 @end defmac
1193
1194 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1195 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1196 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1197
1198 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1199 @end defmac
1200
1201 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1202 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1203 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1204
1205 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1206 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1207 @end defmac
1208
1209 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1210 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1211 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1212 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1213 @end defmac
1214
1215 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1216 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1217 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1218
1219 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1220 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1221 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1222 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1223 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1224
1225 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1226 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1227 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1228 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1229
1230 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1231 structure.
1232
1233 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1234 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1235
1236 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1237 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1238 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1239 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1240
1241 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1242 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1243 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1244
1245 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1246 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1247 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1248
1249 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1250 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1251 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1252
1253 @smallexample
1254 struct foo1
1255 @{
1256 char x;
1257 char :0;
1258 char y;
1259 @};
1260
1261 struct foo2
1262 @{
1263 char x;
1264 int :0;
1265 char y;
1266 @};
1267
1268 main ()
1269 @{
1270 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1271 sizeof (struct foo1));
1272 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1273 sizeof (struct foo2));
1274 exit (0);
1275 @}
1276 @end smallexample
1277
1278 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1279 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1280 @end defmac
1281
1282 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1283 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1284 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1285 @end defmac
1286
1287 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1288 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1289 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1290 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1291 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1292 @end deftypefn
1293
1294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1295 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1296 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1297 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1298
1299 The default is @code{false}.
1300 @end deftypefn
1301
1302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1303 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1304 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1305
1306 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1307 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1308 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1309 retain the field's mode.
1310
1311 Normally, this is not needed.
1312 @end deftypefn
1313
1314 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1315 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1316 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1317 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1318 @var{specified}.
1319
1320 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1321 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1322 @end defmac
1323
1324 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1325 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1326 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1327 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1328 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1329 (DImode)} is assumed.
1330 @end defmac
1331
1332 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1333 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1334 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1335 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1336 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1337 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1338 having its mode specified.
1339
1340 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1341 would most commonly define this macro if the
1342 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1343 64-bit mode.
1344 @end defmac
1345
1346 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1347 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1348 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1349 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1350
1351 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1352 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1353 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1354 @end defmac
1355
1356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1357 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1358 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1359 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1360 targets.
1361 @end deftypefn
1362
1363 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1364 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1365 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1366 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1367 targets.
1368 @end deftypefn
1369
1370 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1371 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1372 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1373 @end deftypefn
1374
1375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1376 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1377 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1378 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1379 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1380 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1381 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1382 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1383 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1384 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1385 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1386 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1387
1388 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1389 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1390 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1391 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1392 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1393 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1394 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1395
1396 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1397 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1398 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1399 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1400 may affect its placement.
1401 @end deftypefn
1402
1403 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1404 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1405 @end deftypefn
1406
1407 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1408 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1409 @end deftypefn
1410
1411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1412 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1413 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1414 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1415 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1416 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1417 usage.
1418 @end deftypefn
1419
1420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1421 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1422 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1423 @end deftypefn
1424
1425 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1426 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1427 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1428 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1429 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1430 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1431 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1432 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1433 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1434 string constant.
1435
1436 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1437 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1438 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1439 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1440 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1441 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1442 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1443 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1444 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1445 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1446 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1447 spaces in your string.
1448
1449 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1450 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1451 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1452 before mangling.
1453
1454 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1455 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1456 types.
1457 @end deftypefn
1458
1459 @node Type Layout
1460 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1461
1462 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1463 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1464 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1465 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1466
1467 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1468 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1469 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1470 @end defmac
1471
1472 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1473 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1474 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1475 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1476 unit.)
1477 @end defmac
1478
1479 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1480 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1481 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1482 @end defmac
1483
1484 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1485 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1486 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1487 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1488 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1489 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1490 @end defmac
1491
1492 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1493 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1494 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1495 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1496 macro must be at least 64.
1497 @end defmac
1498
1499 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1500 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1501 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1502 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1503 @end defmac
1504
1505 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1506 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1507 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1508 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1509 @end defmac
1510
1511 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1512 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1513 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1514 @end defmac
1515
1516 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1517 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1518 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1519 words.
1520 @end defmac
1521
1522 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1523 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1524 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1525 words.
1526 @end defmac
1527
1528 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1529 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1530 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1531 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1532 @end defmac
1533
1534 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1535 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1536 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1537 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1538 @end defmac
1539
1540 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1541 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1542 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1543 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1544 @end defmac
1545
1546 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1547 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1548 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1549 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1550 @end defmac
1551
1552 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1553 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1554 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1555 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1556 @end defmac
1557
1558 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1559 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1560 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1561 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1562 @end defmac
1563
1564 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1565 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1566 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1567 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1568 @end defmac
1569
1570 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1571 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1572 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1573 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1574 @end defmac
1575
1576 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1577 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1578 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1579 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1580 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1581 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1582 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1583 @end defmac
1584
1585 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1586 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1587 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1588 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1589 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1590 is the default.
1591 @end defmac
1592
1593 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1594 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1595 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1596 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1597 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1598 @end defmac
1599
1600 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1601 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1602 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1603 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1604 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1605
1606 The default is to return false.
1607 @end deftypefn
1608
1609 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1610 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1611 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1612 contents of the string.
1613
1614 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1615 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1616 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1617 of the data type names defined in the function
1618 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1619 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1620 compiler to crash on startup.
1621
1622 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1623 int"}.
1624 @end defmac
1625
1626 @defmac SIZETYPE
1627 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1628 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1629 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1630 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1631 is extracted.
1632
1633 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1634
1635 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1636 @end defmac
1637
1638 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1639 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1640 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1641 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1642 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1643
1644 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1645 @end defmac
1646
1647 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1648 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1649 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1650 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1651 information.
1652
1653 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1654 @end defmac
1655
1656 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1657 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1658 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1659 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1660 @end defmac
1661
1662 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1663 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1664 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1665 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1666 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1667 information.
1668
1669 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1670 @end defmac
1671
1672 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1673 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1674 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1675 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1676 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1677
1678 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1679 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1680 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1681 @end defmac
1682
1683 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1684 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1685 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1686 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1687 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1688
1689 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1690 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1691 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1692 int}.
1693 @end defmac
1694
1695 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1696 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1697 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1698 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1699 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1700 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1701 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1702 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1704 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1705 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1706 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1707 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1709 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1710 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1711 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1712 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1713 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1714 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1715 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1716 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1717 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1718 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1719 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1720 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1721 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1722 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1723 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1724 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1725 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1726 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1727 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1728 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1729 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1730 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1731 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1732
1733 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1734 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1735 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1736 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1737 these macros are null pointers.
1738 @end defmac
1739
1740 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1741 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1742 that looks like:
1743
1744 @smallexample
1745 struct @{
1746 union @{
1747 void (*fn)();
1748 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1749 @};
1750 ptrdiff_t delta;
1751 @};
1752 @end smallexample
1753
1754 @noindent
1755 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1756 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1757 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1758 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1759 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1760 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1761 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1762 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1763
1764 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1765 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1766 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1767 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1768 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1769 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1770 architecture, you should define this macro to
1771 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1772
1773 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1774 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1775 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1776 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1777 @end defmac
1778
1779 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1780 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1781 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1782 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1783 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1784 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1785 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1786
1787 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1788 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1789 @end defmac
1790
1791 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1792 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1793 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1794 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1795 when special alignment is necessary. */
1796 @end defmac
1797
1798 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1799 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1800 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1801 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1802 of words in each data entry.
1803 @end defmac
1804
1805 @node Registers
1806 @section Register Usage
1807 @cindex register usage
1808
1809 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1810 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1811
1812 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1813 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1814 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1815 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1816 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1817
1818 @menu
1819 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1820 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1821 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1822 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1823 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1824 @end menu
1825
1826 @node Register Basics
1827 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1828
1829 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1830 Registers have various characteristics.
1831
1832 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1833 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1834 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1835 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1836 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1837 @end defmac
1838
1839 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1840 @cindex fixed register
1841 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1842 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1843 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1844 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1845 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1846 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1847 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1848
1849 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1850 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1851 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1852
1853 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1854 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1855 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1856 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1857 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1858 @end defmac
1859
1860 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1861 @cindex call-used register
1862 @cindex call-clobbered register
1863 @cindex call-saved register
1864 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1865 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1866 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1867 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1868 function calls.
1869
1870 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1871 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1872 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1873
1874 Exactly one of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} and @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}
1875 must be defined. Modern ports should define @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}.
1876 @end defmac
1877
1878 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1879 @cindex call-used register
1880 @cindex call-clobbered register
1881 @cindex call-saved register
1882 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1883 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1884 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1885
1886 Exactly one of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} and @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}
1887 must be defined. Modern ports should define @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}.
1888 @end defmac
1889
1890 @cindex call-used register
1891 @cindex call-clobbered register
1892 @cindex call-saved register
1893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const predefined_function_abi &} TARGET_FNTYPE_ABI (const_tree @var{type})
1894 Return the ABI used by a function with type @var{type}; see the
1895 definition of @code{predefined_function_abi} for details of the ABI
1896 descriptor. Targets only need to define this hook if they support
1897 interoperability between several ABIs in the same translation unit.
1898 @end deftypefn
1899
1900 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const predefined_function_abi &} TARGET_INSN_CALLEE_ABI (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
1901 This hook returns a description of the ABI used by the target of
1902 call instruction @var{insn}; see the definition of
1903 @code{predefined_function_abi} for details of the ABI descriptor.
1904 Only the global function @code{insn_callee_abi} should call this hook
1905 directly.
1906
1907 Targets only need to define this hook if they support
1908 interoperability between several ABIs in the same translation unit.
1909 @end deftypefn
1910
1911 @cindex call-used register
1912 @cindex call-clobbered register
1913 @cindex call-saved register
1914 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (unsigned int @var{abi_id}, unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1915 ABIs usually specify that calls must preserve the full contents
1916 of a particular register, or that calls can alter any part of a
1917 particular register. This information is captured by the target macro
1918 @code{CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS}. However, some ABIs specify that calls
1919 must preserve certain bits of a particular register but can alter others.
1920 This hook should return true if this applies to at least one of the
1921 registers in @samp{(reg:@var{mode} @var{regno})}, and if as a result the
1922 call would alter part of the @var{mode} value. For example, if a call
1923 preserves the low 32 bits of a 64-bit hard register @var{regno} but can
1924 clobber the upper 32 bits, this hook should return true for a 64-bit mode
1925 but false for a 32-bit mode.
1926
1927 The value of @var{abi_id} comes from the @code{predefined_function_abi}
1928 structure that describes the ABI of the call; see the definition of the
1929 structure for more details. If (as is usual) the target uses the same ABI
1930 for all functions in a translation unit, @var{abi_id} is always 0.
1931
1932 The default implementation returns false, which is correct
1933 for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers.
1934 @end deftypefn
1935
1936 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_GET_MULTILIB_ABI_NAME (void)
1937 This hook returns name of multilib ABI name.
1938 @end deftypefn
1939
1940 @findex fixed_regs
1941 @findex call_used_regs
1942 @findex global_regs
1943 @findex reg_names
1944 @findex reg_class_contents
1945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1946 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1947 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1948 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1949 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1950 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1951 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1952 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1953 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1954 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1955 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1956 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1957 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1958 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1959 command options have been applied.
1960
1961 @cindex disabling certain registers
1962 @cindex controlling register usage
1963 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1964 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1965 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1966 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1967 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1968 that shouldn't be used.
1969
1970 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1971 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1972 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1973 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1974 @end deftypefn
1975
1976 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1977 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1978 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1979 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1980 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1981 outbound register.
1982 @end defmac
1983
1984 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1985 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1986 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1987 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1988 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1989 register.
1990 @end defmac
1991
1992 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1993 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1994 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1995 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1996 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1997 gotos.
1998 @end defmac
1999
2000 @defmac PC_REGNUM
2001 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2002 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2003 @end defmac
2004
2005 @node Allocation Order
2006 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2007 @cindex order of register allocation
2008 @cindex register allocation order
2009
2010 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2011 Registers are allocated in order.
2012
2013 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2014 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2015 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2016 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2017
2018 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2019 (all else being equal).
2020
2021 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2022 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2023 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2024 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2025 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2026 @end defmac
2027
2028 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2029 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2030 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2031
2032 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2033 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2034 register; and so on.
2035
2036 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2037 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2038
2039 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2040 @end defmac
2041
2042 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2043 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2044 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2045 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2046 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2047 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
2048 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
2049 @end defmac
2050
2051 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2052 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2053 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2054 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2055 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2056 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2057 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2058 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2059
2060 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2061 @end defmac
2062
2063 @node Values in Registers
2064 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2065
2066 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2067 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2068 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2069
2070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2071 This hook returns the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2072 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2073 @var{mode}. This hook must never return zero, even if a register
2074 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with
2075 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or
2076 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} instead.
2077
2078 The default definition returns the number of words in @var{mode}.
2079 @end deftypefn
2080
2081 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2082 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2083 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2084 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2085 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2086 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2087 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2088
2089 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2090 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2091 nonzero.
2092
2093 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2094 @code{subreg_get_info}
2095 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2096 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2097 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2098 registers and so not be representable.
2099 @end defmac
2100
2101 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2102 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2103 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2104 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2105 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2106 @end defmac
2107
2108 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2109 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2110 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2111 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2112 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2113 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2114 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2115 @end defmac
2116
2117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2118 This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value
2119 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2120 registers starting with that one). The default definition returns true
2121 unconditionally.
2122
2123 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2124 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2125
2126 @cindex register pairs
2127 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2128 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this hook to reject
2129 odd register numbers for such modes.
2130
2131 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2132 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2133 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2134 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2135
2136 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2137 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2138 this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define
2139 patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This is
2140 useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2141 and @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer
2142 modes to be tieable.
2143
2144 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2145 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2146 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2147 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2148 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2149 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2150
2151 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2152 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2153 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2154 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2155 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2156 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2157 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2158 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2159 register, so you can define this hook to say so.
2160
2161 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2162 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2163 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2164 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2165 constraints for those instructions.
2166
2167 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2168 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2169 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2170 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2171 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2172 @end deftypefn
2173
2174 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2175 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2176 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2177
2178 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2179 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2180 handler.
2181
2182 The default is always nonzero.
2183 @end defmac
2184
2185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2})
2186 This hook returns true if a value of mode @var{mode1} is accessible
2187 in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2188
2189 If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2190 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always
2191 the same for any @var{r}, then
2192 @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2193 should be true. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2194 this hook to return false unless some other mechanism ensures the
2195 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2196
2197 You should define this hook to return true in as many cases as
2198 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2199 allocation. The default definition returns true unconditionally.
2200 @end deftypefn
2201
2202 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2203 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2204 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2205
2206 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2207 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2208
2209 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2210 @end deftypefn
2211
2212 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2213 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2214 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2215 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2216 @end defmac
2217
2218 @node Leaf Functions
2219 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2220
2221 @cindex leaf functions
2222 @cindex functions, leaf
2223 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2224 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2225 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2226 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2227 normally arrive.
2228
2229 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2230 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2231 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2232 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2233 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2234 functions''.
2235
2236 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2237 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2238 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2239 accomplish this.
2240
2241 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2242 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2243 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2244 function treatment.
2245
2246 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2247 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2248 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2249 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2250 in this vector.
2251
2252 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2253 the treatment of leaf functions.
2254 @end defmac
2255
2256 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2257 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2258 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2259
2260 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2261 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2262 will cause the compiler to abort.
2263
2264 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2265 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2266 this.
2267 @end defmac
2268
2269 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2270 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2271 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2272 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2273 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2274 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2275 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2276 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2277 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2278 functions which only use leaf registers.
2279 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2280 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2281 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2282 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2283 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2284
2285 @node Stack Registers
2286 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2287
2288 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2289 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2290 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2291 stack.
2292
2293 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2294 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2295 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2296 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2297 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2298 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2299 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2300
2301 @defmac STACK_REGS
2302 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2303 @end defmac
2304
2305 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2306 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2307 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2308 @end defmac
2309
2310 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2311 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2312 of the stack.
2313 @end defmac
2314
2315 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2316 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2317 the stack.
2318 @end defmac
2319
2320 @node Register Classes
2321 @section Register Classes
2322 @cindex register class definitions
2323 @cindex class definitions, register
2324
2325 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2326 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2327 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2328 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2329
2330 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2331 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2332 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2333
2334 @findex ALL_REGS
2335 @findex NO_REGS
2336 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2337 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2338 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2339 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2340
2341 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2342 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2343 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2344 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2345 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2346 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2347
2348 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2349 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2350
2351 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2352 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2353 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2354 them in operand constraints.
2355
2356 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2357 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2358 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2359 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2360 (@pxref{Costs}).
2361
2362 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2363 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2364 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2365 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2366 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2367 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2368 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2369
2370 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2371 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2372 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2373 in their union.
2374
2375 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2376 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2377 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2378 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2379 specify this requirement is with @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2380
2381 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2382 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2383 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2384 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2385 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2386 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2387 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2388 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2389 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2390
2391 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2392 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2393 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2394 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2395 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2396 tells how many classes there are.
2397
2398 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2399 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2400 in many of the tables described below.
2401 @end deftp
2402
2403 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2404 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2405
2406 @smallexample
2407 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2408 @end smallexample
2409 @end defmac
2410
2411 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2412 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2413 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2414 @end defmac
2415
2416 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2417 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2418 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2419 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2420 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2421
2422 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2423 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2424 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2425 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2426 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2427 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2428 so on.
2429 @end defmac
2430
2431 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2432 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2433 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2434 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2435 register.
2436 @end defmac
2437
2438 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2439 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2440 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2441 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2442 @end defmac
2443
2444 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2445 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2446 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2447 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2448 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2449 @end defmac
2450
2451 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2452 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2453 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2454 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2455 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2456 @end defmac
2457
2458 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2459 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2460 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2461 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2462 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2463 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2464 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2465 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2466 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2467 @end defmac
2468
2469 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2470 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2471 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2472 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2473 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2474 @end defmac
2475
2476 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2477 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2478 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2479 @end defmac
2480
2481 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2482 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2483 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2484 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2485 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2486 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2487 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2488 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2489 @code{address_operand}.
2490 @end defmac
2491
2492 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2493 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2494 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2495 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2496 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2497 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2498 than other base register uses.
2499
2500 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2501 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2502 @end defmac
2503
2504 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2505 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2506 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2507 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2508 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2509 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2510 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2511 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2512 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2513 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2514 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2515 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2516 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2517 @end defmac
2518
2519 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2520 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2521 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2522 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2523 allocated such a hard register.
2524
2525 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2526 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2527 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2528 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2529 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2530 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2531 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2532 only if neither labeling works.
2533 @end defmac
2534
2535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2536 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2537 @end deftypefn
2538
2539 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2540 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2541 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2542 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2543 another, smaller class.
2544
2545 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2546
2547 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2548 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2549 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2550 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2551 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2552
2553 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2554 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2555 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2556 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2557 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2558 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2559 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2560 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2561 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2562 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2563 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2564
2565 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2566 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2567 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2568 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2569 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2570 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2571 @end deftypefn
2572
2573 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2574 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2575 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2576 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2577 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2578 safe:
2579
2580 @smallexample
2581 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2582 @end smallexample
2583
2584 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2585 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2586 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2587 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2588 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2589
2590 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2591 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2592 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2593 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2594 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2595 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2596 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2597 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant cannot be loaded
2598 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2599 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2600 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2601
2602 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2603 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2604 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2605 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2606 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2607 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2608 @end defmac
2609
2610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2611 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2612 input reloads.
2613
2614 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2615 argument.
2616
2617 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2618 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2619 @end deftypefn
2620
2621 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2622 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2623 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2624 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2625 ordinarily be used.
2626
2627 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2628 there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes.
2629
2630 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2631 smaller class.
2632
2633 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2634 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2635 @end defmac
2636
2637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2638 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2639 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2640 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2641 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2642 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2643 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2644 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2645 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2646 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2647 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2648 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2649 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2650
2651 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2652 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2653 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2654 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2655 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2656 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2657 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2658 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2659 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2660 of the scratch register(s).
2661
2662 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2663
2664 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2665 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2666 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2667 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2668 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2669
2670 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2671 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2672 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2673 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2674 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2675 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2676
2677 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2678 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2679 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2680 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2681 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2682
2683 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2684 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2685 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2686 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2687 single-register-class
2688 @c [later: or memory]
2689 output constraint.
2690
2691 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2692 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2693 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2694 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2695
2696 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2697 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2698 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2699 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2700 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2701 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2702 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2703 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2704
2705
2706 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2707 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2708 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2709 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2710
2711 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2712 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2713 to use @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2714
2715 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2716 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2717 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2718 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2719 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2720 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2721 @end deftypefn
2722
2723 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2724 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2725 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2726 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2727 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2728
2729 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2730 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2731 reload phase that it may
2732 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2733 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2734 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2735 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2736 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2737 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2738
2739 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2740 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2741 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2742 class required. If the
2743 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2744 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2745 macros identically.
2746
2747 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2748 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2749 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2750 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2751 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2752
2753 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2754 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2755 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2756 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2757 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2758 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2759 register.
2760
2761 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2762 register that
2763 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2764 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2765 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2766 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2767 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2768
2769 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2770 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2771 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2772 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2773
2774 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2775 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2776 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2777 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2778 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2779 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2780 general registers.
2781 @end defmac
2782
2783 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{class1}, reg_class_t @var{class2})
2784 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2785 to some other registers without using memory. Define this hook on
2786 those machines to return true if objects of mode @var{m} in registers
2787 of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of class @var{class2} by
2788 storing a register of @var{class1} into memory and loading that memory
2789 location into a register of @var{class2}. The default definition returns
2790 false for all inputs.
2791 @end deftypefn
2792
2793 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2794 Normally when @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2795 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2796 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2797 defined by this macro.
2798
2799 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2800 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2801 @end defmac
2802
2803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
2804 If @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} tells the compiler to use memory
2805 when moving between two particular registers of mode @var{mode},
2806 this hook specifies the mode that the memory should have.
2807
2808 The default depends on @code{TARGET_LRA_P}. Without LRA, the default
2809 is to use a word-sized mode for integral modes that are smaller than a
2810 a word. This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures
2811 that all bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the
2812 registers in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for
2813 floating-point registers.
2814
2815 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2816 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2817 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2818 widening will not work correctly and you must define this hook to
2819 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.c} for
2820 details.
2821
2822 With LRA, the default is to use @var{mode} unmodified.
2823 @end deftypefn
2824
2825 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SELECT_EARLY_REMAT_MODES (sbitmap @var{modes})
2826 On some targets, certain modes cannot be held in registers around a
2827 standard ABI call and are relatively expensive to spill to the stack.
2828 The early rematerialization pass can help in such cases by aggressively
2829 recomputing values after calls, so that they don't need to be spilled.
2830
2831 This hook returns the set of such modes by setting the associated bits
2832 in @var{modes}. The default implementation selects no modes, which has
2833 the effect of disabling the early rematerialization pass.
2834 @end deftypefn
2835
2836 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2837 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2838 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2839 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2840
2841 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2842 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2843 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2844 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2845 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2846
2847 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2848 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2849 pressure.
2850 @end deftypefn
2851
2852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2853 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2854 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2855
2856 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.
2857 In fact, the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2858 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2859 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2860 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2861
2862 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2863 in the reload pass.
2864
2865 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2866 in words.
2867 @end deftypefn
2868
2869 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2870 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2871 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2872
2873 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2874 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2875 should be the maximum value of @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2876 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2877
2878 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2879 in the reload pass.
2880 @end defmac
2881
2882 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (machine_mode @var{from}, machine_mode @var{to}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2883 This hook returns true if it is possible to bitcast values held in
2884 registers of class @var{rclass} from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to}
2885 and if doing so preserves the low-order bits that are common to both modes.
2886 The result is only meaningful if @var{rclass} has registers that can hold
2887 both @code{from} and @code{to}. The default implementation returns true.
2888
2889 As an example of when such bitcasting is invalid, loading 32-bit integer or
2890 floating-point objects into floating-point registers on Alpha extends them
2891 to 64 bits. Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a
2892 32-bit object does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case
2893 for a normal register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines
2894 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} to return:
2895
2896 @smallexample
2897 (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to)
2898 || !reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, rclass))
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2902 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{rclass} are wider
2903 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2904 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2905 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2906 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2907 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2908 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2909 value that the middle-end intended.
2910 @end deftypefn
2911
2912 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2913 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2914 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2915
2916 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2917 @end deftypefn
2918
2919 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2920 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2921 @end deftypefn
2922
2923 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2924 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2925 @end deftypefn
2926
2927 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2928 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2929 @end deftypefn
2930
2931 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2932 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2933 @end deftypefn
2934
2935 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2936 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2937 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2938 register allocation.
2939 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2940 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2941 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2942 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2943 @end deftypefn
2944
2945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{offset1}, rtx *@var{offset2}, poly_int64 @var{orig_offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2946 This hook tries to split address offset @var{orig_offset} into
2947 two parts: one that should be added to the base address to create
2948 a local anchor point, and an additional offset that can be applied
2949 to the anchor to address a value of mode @var{mode}. The idea is that
2950 the local anchor could be shared by other accesses to nearby locations.
2951
2952 The hook returns true if it succeeds, storing the offset of the
2953 anchor from the base in @var{offset1} and the offset of the final address
2954 from the anchor in @var{offset2}. The default implementation returns false.
2955 @end deftypefn
2956
2957 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2958 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2959 @end deftypefn
2960
2961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2962 This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2963 @end deftypefn
2964
2965 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2966 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2967 @end deftypefn
2968
2969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2970 A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2971 @end deftypefn
2972
2973 @node Stack and Calling
2974 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2975 @cindex calling conventions
2976
2977 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2978 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2979
2980 @menu
2981 * Frame Layout::
2982 * Exception Handling::
2983 * Stack Checking::
2984 * Frame Registers::
2985 * Elimination::
2986 * Stack Arguments::
2987 * Register Arguments::
2988 * Scalar Return::
2989 * Aggregate Return::
2990 * Caller Saves::
2991 * Function Entry::
2992 * Profiling::
2993 * Tail Calls::
2994 * Shrink-wrapping separate components::
2995 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2996 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2997 @end menu
2998
2999 @node Frame Layout
3000 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
3001 @cindex stack frame layout
3002 @cindex frame layout
3003
3004 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3005 Here is the basic stack layout.
3006
3007 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3008 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3009 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
3010 @end defmac
3011
3012 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3013 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3014 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3015 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3016
3017 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3018 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3019 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3020 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3021 space for the next item on the stack.
3022
3023 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3024 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3025 which is often wrong.
3026 @end defmac
3027
3028 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3029 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3030 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3031 @end defmac
3032
3033 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3034 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3035 addresses on the stack.
3036 @end defmac
3037
3038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET (void)
3039 This hook returns the offset from the frame pointer to the first local
3040 variable slot to be allocated. If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, it is the
3041 offset to @emph{end} of the first slot allocated, otherwise it is the
3042 offset to @emph{beginning} of the first slot allocated. The default
3043 implementation returns 0.
3044 @end deftypefn
3045
3046 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3047 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3048 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3049
3050 On ports where @code{TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3051 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3052 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3053 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3054 @end defmac
3055
3056 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3057 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3058 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3059 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3060
3061 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3062 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3063 @end defmac
3064
3065 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3066 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3067 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3068 function.
3069
3070 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3071 the first argument's address.
3072 @end defmac
3073
3074 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3075 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3076 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3077
3078 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3079 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3080 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3081 @end defmac
3082
3083 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3084 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3085 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3086 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3087 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3088 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3089 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3090 @end defmac
3091
3092 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3093 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3094 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3095 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3096 itself.
3097
3098 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3099 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3100 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3101 @end defmac
3102
3103 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3104 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3105 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3106 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3107 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3108 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3109 @end defmac
3110
3111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3112 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3113 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3114 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3115 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3116 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3117 @end deftypefn
3118
3119 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3120 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3121 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3122 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3123 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3124 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3125 @end defmac
3126
3127 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3128 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3129 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3130 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3131 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3132 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3133
3134 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3135 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3136 determine the return address of other frames.
3137 @end defmac
3138
3139 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3140 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3141 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3142 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3143 @end defmac
3144
3145 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3146 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3147 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3148 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3149 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3150 the stack.
3151
3152 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3153 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3154
3155 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3156 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3157 @end defmac
3158
3159 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3160 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3161 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3162 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3163 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3164
3165 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3166 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3167 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3168 over time.
3169 @end defmac
3170
3171 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3172 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3173 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3174 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3175 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3176 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3177 @end defmac
3178
3179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3180 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3181 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3182 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3183 @smallexample
3184 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3185 @end smallexample
3186 and
3187 @smallexample
3188 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3189 @end smallexample
3190 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3191 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3192 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3193 @end deftypefn
3194
3195 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_DWARF_POLY_INDETERMINATE_VALUE (unsigned int @var{i}, unsigned int *@var{factor}, int *@var{offset})
3196 Express the value of @code{poly_int} indeterminate @var{i} as a DWARF
3197 expression, with @var{i} counting from 1. Return the number of a DWARF
3198 register @var{R} and set @samp{*@var{factor}} and @samp{*@var{offset}} such
3199 that the value of the indeterminate is:
3200 @smallexample
3201 value_of(@var{R}) / @var{factor} - @var{offset}
3202 @end smallexample
3203
3204 A target only needs to define this hook if it sets
3205 @samp{NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS} to a value greater than 1.
3206 @end deftypefn
3207
3208 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3209 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3210 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3211 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3212 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3213 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3214
3215 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3216 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3217 @end defmac
3218
3219 @defmac DEFAULT_INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3220 Like @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}, but must be the same for all
3221 functions of the same ABI, and when using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives
3222 must also agree with the default CFI GAS emits. Define this macro
3223 only if @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} can have different values
3224 between different functions of the same ABI or when
3225 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} does not agree with GAS default CFI.
3226 @end defmac
3227
3228 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3229 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3230 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3231 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3232 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3233 during virtual register instantiation.
3234
3235 The default value for this macro is
3236 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3237 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3238 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3239 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3240 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3241
3242 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3243 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3244 DWARF 2.
3245 @end defmac
3246
3247 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3248 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3249 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3250 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3251 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3252
3253 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3254 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3255 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3256 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3257 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3258 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3259 should be defined.
3260 @end defmac
3261
3262 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3263 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3264 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3265 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3266 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3267 @end defmac
3268
3269 @node Exception Handling
3270 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3271 @cindex exception handling
3272
3273 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3274 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3275 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3276 @var{N} registers are usable.
3277
3278 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3279 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3280 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3281 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3282 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3283
3284 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3285 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3286 @end defmac
3287
3288 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3289 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3290 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3291 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3292 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3293
3294 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3295 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3296
3297 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3298 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3299 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3300 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3301 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3302 that provided by DWARF 2.
3303 @end defmac
3304
3305 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3306 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3307 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3308 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3309
3310 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3311 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3312 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3313 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3314 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3315 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3316 target call frame.
3317
3318 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3319 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3320 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3321
3322 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3323 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3324 @end defmac
3325
3326 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3327 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3328 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3329 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3330 using it to return to the exception handler.
3331 @end defmac
3332
3333 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3334 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3335 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3336 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3337 and so may be read-only.
3338
3339 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3340 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3341 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3342 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3343
3344 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3345 represented directly.
3346 @end defmac
3347
3348 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3349 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3350 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3351 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3352 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3353
3354 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3355 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3356 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3357 to be emitted.
3358 @end defmac
3359
3360 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3361 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3362 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3363 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3364 through signal frames.
3365
3366 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3367 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3368 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3369 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3370 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3371 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3372 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3373 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3374 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3375
3376 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3377 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3378 @end defmac
3379
3380 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3381 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3382 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3383 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3384
3385 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3386 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3387 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3388 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3389 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3390 be updated in @var{fs}.
3391 @end defmac
3392
3393 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3394 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3395 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3396 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3397 @end defmac
3398
3399 @node Stack Checking
3400 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3401
3402 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3403 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3404 three ways:
3405
3406 @enumerate
3407 @item
3408 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3409 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3410 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3411 other special processing.
3412
3413 @item
3414 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3415 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3416 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3417 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3418 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3419 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3420 approach below.
3421
3422 @item
3423 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3424 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3425 @end enumerate
3426
3427 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3428 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3429 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3430 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3431
3432 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3433 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3434 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3435 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3436 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3437 value of this macro is zero.
3438 @end defmac
3439
3440 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3441 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3442 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3443 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3444 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3445 @end defmac
3446
3447 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3448 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3449 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3450 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3451 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3452 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3453 @end defmac
3454
3455 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3456 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3457 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3458 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3459 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3460 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3461 default value of this macro is zero.
3462 @end defmac
3463
3464 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3465 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3466 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3467 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3468 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3469 architectures and operating systems.
3470 @end defmac
3471
3472 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3473 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3474 in the opposite case.
3475
3476 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3477 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3478 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3479 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3480 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3481 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3482 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3483 @end defmac
3484
3485 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3486 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3487 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3488 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3489 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3490 use the default of four words.
3491 @end defmac
3492
3493 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3494 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3495 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3496 @option{-fstack-check}.
3497 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3498 normally not need to override that default.
3499 @end defmac
3500
3501 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STACK_CLASH_PROTECTION_ALLOCA_PROBE_RANGE (void)
3502 Some targets have an ABI defined interval for which no probing needs to be done.
3503 When a probe does need to be done this same interval is used as the probe distance up when doing stack clash protection for alloca.
3504 On such targets this value can be set to override the default probing up interval.
3505 Define this variable to return nonzero if such a probe range is required or zero otherwise. Defining this hook also requires your functions which make use of alloca to have at least 8 byesof outgoing arguments. If this is not the case the stack will be corrupted.
3506 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value zero.
3507 @end deftypefn
3508
3509 @need 2000
3510 @node Frame Registers
3511 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3512
3513 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3514 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3515
3516 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3517 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3518 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3519 the hardware determines which register this is.
3520 @end defmac
3521
3522 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3523 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3524 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3525 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3526 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3527 @end defmac
3528
3529 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3530 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3531 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3532 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3533 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3534 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3535 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3536 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3537 used for the frame pointer.
3538
3539 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3540 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3541 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3542 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3543 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3544 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3545 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3546
3547 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3548 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3549 @end defmac
3550
3551 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3552 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3553 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3554 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3555 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3556 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3557 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3558 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3559 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3560 @end defmac
3561
3562 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3563 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3564 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3565 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3566 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3567 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3568 @end defmac
3569
3570 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3571 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3572 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3573 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3574 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3575 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3576 @end defmac
3577
3578 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3579 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3580 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3581 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3582 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3583 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3584 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3585
3586 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3587 address from the stack.
3588 @end defmac
3589
3590 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3591 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3592 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3593 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3594 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3595 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3596 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3597 not be defined.
3598
3599 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3600
3601 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3602 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3603 @end defmac
3604
3605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3606 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3607 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3608 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3609 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3610 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3611
3612 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3613
3614 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3615 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3616 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3617 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3618 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3619 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3620 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3621 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3622 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3623 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3624 to refer to those items.
3625 @end deftypefn
3626
3627 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3628 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3629 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3630 DWARF2 exception handling.
3631
3632 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3633 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3634 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3635 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3636 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3637 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3638 registers that are not call-saved.
3639
3640 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3641 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3642 @end defmac
3643
3644 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3645
3646 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3647 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3648
3649 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3650 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3651 @end defmac
3652
3653 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3654
3655 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3656 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3657 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3658 column number to use instead.
3659 @end defmac
3660
3661 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3662
3663 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3664 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3665 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3666 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3667 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3668
3669 @end defmac
3670
3671 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3672
3673 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3674 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3675 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3676 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3677 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3678
3679 @end defmac
3680
3681 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3682
3683 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3684 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3685 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3686 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3687
3688 @end defmac
3689
3690 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3691
3692 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3693 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3694 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3695 defined and 0 otherwise.
3696
3697 @end defmac
3698
3699 @defmac DWARF_LAZY_REGISTER_VALUE (@var{regno}, @var{value})
3700 Define this macro if the target has pseudo DWARF registers whose
3701 values need to be computed lazily on demand by the unwinder (such as when
3702 referenced in a CFA expression). The macro returns true if @var{regno}
3703 is such a register and stores its value in @samp{*@var{value}} if so.
3704 @end defmac
3705
3706 @node Elimination
3707 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3708
3709 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3710 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3711
3712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3713 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3714 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3715 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3716
3717 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3718 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3719 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3720 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3721 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3722 pointer.
3723
3724 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3725 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3726 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3727 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
3728 them.
3729
3730 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3731 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3732 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3733
3734 Default return value is @code{false}.
3735 @end deftypefn
3736
3737 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3738 This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3739 unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3740
3741 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3742 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3743
3744 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3745 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3746 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3747 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3748 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3749
3750 In this case, you might specify:
3751 @smallexample
3752 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3753 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3754 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3755 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3756 @end smallexample
3757
3758 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3759 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3760 @end defmac
3761
3762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3763 This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3764 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3765 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3766 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3767 knows about.
3768
3769 Default return value is @code{true}.
3770 @end deftypefn
3771
3772 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3773 This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3774 of registers. The value would be computed from information
3775 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3776 registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3777 @end defmac
3778
3779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void)
3780 This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be
3781 recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then
3782 be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the
3783 layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful
3784 for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing
3785 this callback is optional.
3786 @end deftypefn
3787
3788 @node Stack Arguments
3789 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3790 @cindex arguments on stack
3791 @cindex stack arguments
3792
3793 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3794 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3795 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3796
3797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3798 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3799 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3800 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3801 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3802 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3803 @end deftypefn
3804
3805 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3806 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3807 outgoing arguments.
3808 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3809 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3810 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3811 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3812 @end defmac
3813
3814 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3815 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3816 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3817 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3818 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3819 @end defmac
3820
3821 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3822 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3823 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3824
3825 On some machines, the definition
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3829 @end smallexample
3830
3831 @noindent
3832 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3833 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3834 alignment. Then the definition should be
3835
3836 @smallexample
3837 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3838 @end smallexample
3839
3840 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3841 @end defmac
3842
3843 @findex outgoing_args_size
3844 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3845 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3846 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3847 will be computed and placed into
3848 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3849 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3850 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3851
3852 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3853 is not proper.
3854 @end defmac
3855
3856 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3857 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3858 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3859 registers.
3860
3861 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3862 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3863 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3864 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3865 of the function.
3866
3867 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3868 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3869 which.
3870 @end defmac
3871 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3872 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3873
3874 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3875 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3876 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3877 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3878 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3879 @end defmac
3880
3881 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3882 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3883 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3884 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3885 if the function called is a library function.
3886
3887 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3888 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3889 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3890 @end defmac
3891
3892 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3893 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3894 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3895 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3896 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3897
3898 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3899 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3900 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3901 stack in its natural location.
3902 @end defmac
3903
3904 @deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_int64 TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, poly_int64 @var{size})
3905 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3906 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3907 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3908
3909 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3910 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3911 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3912 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3913
3914 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3915 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3916 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3917 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3918 arguments (if known).
3919
3920 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3921 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3922 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3923 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3924 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3925 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3926
3927 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3928 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3929 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3930
3931 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3932 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3933 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3934 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3935 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3936 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3937 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3938 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3939 number of arguments.
3940 @end deftypefn
3941
3942 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3943 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3944 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3945 when compiling a function call.
3946
3947 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3948 have been accumulated.
3949
3950 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3951 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3952 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3953 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3954 appropriate.
3955 @end defmac
3956
3957 @node Register Arguments
3958 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3959 @cindex arguments in registers
3960 @cindex registers arguments
3961
3962 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3963 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3964 the stack.
3965
3966 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
3967 Return an RTX indicating whether function argument @var{arg} is passed
3968 in a register and if so, which register. Argument @var{ca} summarizes all
3969 the previous arguments.
3970
3971 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3972 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3973 on the stack.
3974
3975 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3976 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3977 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3978 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3979 for more information.
3980
3981 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3982 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3983 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3984 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3985 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3986 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3987 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3988 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3989 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3990 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3991 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3992 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3993 argument is also stored on the stack.
3994
3995 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3996 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3997 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3998
3999 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4000 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4001 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4002 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4003 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4004 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4005
4006 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4007 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4008 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4009 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4010 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4011 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4012 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4013 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4014 a register.
4015 @end deftypefn
4016
4017 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4018 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{arg}
4019 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4020 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4021 documentation.
4022 @end deftypefn
4023
4024 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4025 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
4026 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
4027 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
4028 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
4029
4030 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4031 which the caller passes the value, and
4032 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4033 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4034 arrive.
4035
4036 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
4037 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
4038 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
4039
4040 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4041 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4042 @end deftypefn
4043
4044 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
4045 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
4046 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
4047 @end deftypefn
4048
4049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
4050 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
4051 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
4052 @end deftypefn
4053
4054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4055 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4056 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4057 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4058 pushed on the stack.
4059
4060 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4061 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4062 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4063 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4064 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4065 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4066 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4067
4068 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4069 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4070 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4071 @end deftypefn
4072
4073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4074 This target hook should return @code{true} if argument @var{arg} at the
4075 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4076 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4077 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (@var{arg}.type)}.
4078
4079 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4080 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4081 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4082 to that type.
4083 @end deftypefn
4084
4085 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4086 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4087 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4088 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4089 by the caller.
4090
4091 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4092 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4093 not be generated.
4094
4095 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4096 @end deftypefn
4097
4098 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4099 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4100 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4101 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4102 of bytes of argument so far.
4103
4104 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4105 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4106 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4107 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4108 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4109 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4110 @end defmac
4111
4112 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4113 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4114 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4115 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4116 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4117 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4118 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4119 @end defmac
4120
4121 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4122 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4123 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4124 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4125 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4126 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4127 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4128 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4129 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4130 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4131 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4132 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4133 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4134
4135 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4136 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4137 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4138 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4139 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4140 never both of them at once.
4141 @end defmac
4142
4143 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4144 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4145 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4146 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4147 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4148 0)} is used instead.
4149 @end defmac
4150
4151 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4152 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4153 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4154 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4155
4156 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4157 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4158 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4159 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4160 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4161 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4162 @end defmac
4163
4164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg})
4165 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4166 advance past argument @var{arg} in the argument list. Once this is done,
4167 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4168 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4169
4170 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4171 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4172 used for arguments without any special help.
4173 @end deftypefn
4174
4175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4176 This hook returns the number of bytes to add to the offset of an
4177 argument of type @var{type} and mode @var{mode} when passed in memory.
4178 This is needed for the SPU, which passes @code{char} and @code{short}
4179 arguments in the preferred slot that is in the middle of the quad word
4180 instead of starting at the top. The default implementation returns 0.
4181 @end deftypefn
4182
4183 @deftypefn {Target Hook} pad_direction TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4184 This hook determines whether, and in which direction, to pad out
4185 an argument of mode @var{mode} and type @var{type}. It returns
4186 @code{PAD_UPWARD} to insert padding above the argument, @code{PAD_DOWNWARD}
4187 to insert padding below the argument, or @code{PAD_NONE} to inhibit padding.
4188
4189 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this hook, but by
4190 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is always just enough
4191 to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4192
4193 This hook has a default definition that is right for most systems.
4194 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4195 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4196 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4197 @end deftypefn
4198
4199 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4200 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4201 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4202 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4203 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4204 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4205 @end defmac
4206
4207 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4208 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4209 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4210 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4211 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4212 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4213 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4214 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4215 required.
4216 @end defmac
4217
4218 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4219 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4220 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4221 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4222 @end deftypefn
4223
4224 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4225 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4226 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4227 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4228 value.
4229 @end deftypefn
4230
4231 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4232 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4233 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4234 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4235 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4236 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4237 stack.
4238 @end defmac
4239
4240 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4241 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4242 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4243 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4244 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4245 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4246 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4247 point register.
4248
4249 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4250 false.
4251 @end deftypefn
4252
4253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4254 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4255 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4256 @end deftypefn
4257
4258 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4259 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4260 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4261 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4262 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4263 variable.
4264 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4265 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4266 internal type.
4267 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4268 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4269 macro to iterate through all types.
4270 @end deftypefn
4271
4272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4273 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4274 @var{fndecl}.
4275 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4276 @end deftypefn
4277
4278 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4279 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4280 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4281 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4282 @end deftypefn
4283
4284 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4285 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4286 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4287 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4288 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4289 @end deftypefn
4290
4291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode})
4292 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4293 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4294 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4295 @end deftypefn
4296
4297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (ao_ref *@var{ref})
4298 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4299 @end deftypefn
4300
4301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_TRANSLATE_MODE_ATTRIBUTE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4302 Define this hook if during mode attribute processing, the port should
4303 translate machine_mode @var{mode} to another mode. For example, rs6000's
4304 @code{KFmode}, when it is the same as @code{TFmode}.
4305
4306 The default version of the hook returns that mode that was passed in.
4307 @end deftypefn
4308
4309 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_mode @var{mode})
4310 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4311 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4312 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4313 must work.
4314
4315 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4316 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4317 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4318 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4319 @end deftypefn
4320
4321 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4322 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4323 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4324 must have move patterns for this mode.
4325 @end deftypefn
4326
4327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMPATIBLE_VECTOR_TYPES_P (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4328 Return true if there is no target-specific reason for treating
4329 vector types @var{type1} and @var{type2} as distinct types. The caller
4330 has already checked for target-independent reasons, meaning that the
4331 types are known to have the same mode, to have the same number of elements,
4332 and to have what the caller considers to be compatible element types.
4333
4334 The main reason for defining this hook is to reject pairs of types
4335 that are handled differently by the target's calling convention.
4336 For example, when a new @var{N}-bit vector architecture is added
4337 to a target, the target may want to handle normal @var{N}-bit
4338 @code{VECTOR_TYPE} arguments and return values in the same way as
4339 before, to maintain backwards compatibility. However, it may also
4340 provide new, architecture-specific @code{VECTOR_TYPE}s that are passed
4341 and returned in a more efficient way. It is then important to maintain
4342 a distinction between the ``normal'' @code{VECTOR_TYPE}s and the new
4343 architecture-specific ones.
4344
4345 The default implementation returns true, which is correct for most targets.
4346 @end deftypefn
4347
4348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_ARRAY_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4349 Return the mode that GCC should use for an array that has
4350 @var{nelems} elements, with each element having mode @var{mode}.
4351 Return no mode if the target has no special requirements. In the
4352 latter case, GCC looks for an integer mode of the appropriate size
4353 if available and uses BLKmode otherwise. Usually the search for the
4354 integer mode is limited to @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE}, but the
4355 @code{TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} hook allows a larger mode to be
4356 used in specific cases.
4357
4358 The main use of this hook is to specify that an array of vectors should
4359 also have a vector mode. The default implementation returns no mode.
4360 @end deftypefn
4361
4362 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4363 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4364 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4365 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4366 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4367
4368 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4369 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4370 has operations like:
4371
4372 @smallexample
4373 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 where the return type is defined as:
4377
4378 @smallexample
4379 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4380 @{
4381 int8x8_t val[3];
4382 @} int8x8x3_t;
4383 @end smallexample
4384
4385 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4386 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4387 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4388 @end deftypefn
4389
4390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_float_mode @var{mode})
4391 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4392 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4393 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4394 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4395 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4396 @end deftypefn
4397
4398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_scalar_float_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4399 Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4400 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4401 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type is not
4402 supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The default version of
4403 this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4404 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4405 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4406 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4407 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4408 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4409 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4410 @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The hook is only called for values
4411 of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to
4412 ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or,
4413 if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4414 @end deftypefn
4415
4416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOATN_BUILTIN_P (int @var{func})
4417 Define this to return true if the @code{_Float@var{n}} and
4418 @code{_Float@var{n}x} built-in functions should implicitly enable the
4419 built-in function without the @code{__builtin_} prefix in addition to the
4420 normal built-in function with the @code{__builtin_} prefix. The default is
4421 to only enable built-in functions without the @code{__builtin_} prefix for
4422 the GNU C langauge. In strict ANSI/ISO mode, the built-in function without
4423 the @code{__builtin_} prefix is not enabled. The argument @code{FUNC} is the
4424 @code{enum built_in_function} id of the function to be enabled.
4425 @end deftypefn
4426
4427 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4428 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4429 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4430 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4431 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4432 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4433 for any mode.
4434
4435 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4436 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4437 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4438 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4439 insn.
4440
4441 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4442 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4443 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4444 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4445 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4446 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4447 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4448 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4449 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4450
4451 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4452 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4453 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4454 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4455 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4456 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4457 @end deftypefn
4458
4459 @node Scalar Return
4460 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4461 @cindex return values in registers
4462 @cindex values, returned by functions
4463 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4464
4465 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4466 values---values that can fit in registers.
4467
4468 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4469
4470 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4471 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4472 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4473 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4474 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4475 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4476 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4477 a function returns a value.
4478
4479 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4480 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4481 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4482 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4483 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4484 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4485 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4486 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4487 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4488 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4489 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4490 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4491
4492 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4493 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4494 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4495
4496 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4497 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4498 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4499 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4500 known.
4501
4502 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4503 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4504 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4505 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4506
4507 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4508 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4509 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4510 @end deftypefn
4511
4512 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4513 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4514 a new target instead.
4515 @end defmac
4516
4517 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4518 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4519 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4520
4521 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4522 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4523 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4524 compiled.
4525 @end defmac
4526
4527 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4528 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4529 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4530
4531 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4532 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4533 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4534
4535 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4536 @end deftypefn
4537
4538 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4539 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4540 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4541
4542 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4543 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4544 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4545 suffices:
4546
4547 @smallexample
4548 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4549 @end smallexample
4550
4551 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4552 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4553 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4554
4555 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4556 for a new target instead.
4557 @end defmac
4558
4559 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4560 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4561 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4562
4563 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4564 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4565 recognized by this target hook.
4566
4567 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4568 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4569 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4570
4571 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4572 @end deftypefn
4573
4574 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4575 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4576 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4577 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4578 @end defmac
4579
4580 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4581 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4582 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4583 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4584 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4585 undesirable on your target.
4586 @end deftypevr
4587
4588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4589 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4590 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4591 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4592 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4593
4594 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4595 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4596 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4597 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4598 @code{SImode} rtx.
4599 @end deftypefn
4600
4601 @node Aggregate Return
4602 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4603 @cindex aggregates as return values
4604 @cindex large return values
4605 @cindex returning aggregate values
4606 @cindex structure value address
4607
4608 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4609 cases), the value is not returned according to
4610 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4611 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4612 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4613 address}.
4614
4615 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4616 memory.
4617
4618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4619 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4620 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4621 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4622 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4623 libcalls.
4624
4625 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4626 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4627 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4628 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4629 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4630 values, and 0 otherwise.
4631
4632 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4633 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4634 to indicate this.
4635 @end deftypefn
4636
4637 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4638 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4639 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4640 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4641 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4642 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4643 target hook.
4644
4645 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4646 @end defmac
4647
4648 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4649 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4650 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4651 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4652 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4653 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4654 argument.
4655
4656 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4657 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4658 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4659 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4660 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4661 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4662 the caller.
4663
4664 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4665 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4666 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4667 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4668 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4669 @end deftypefn
4670
4671 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4672 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4673 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4674 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4675
4676 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4677 pass an address to the subroutine.
4678
4679 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4680 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4681 @end defmac
4682
4683 @deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4684 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4685 @end deftypefn
4686
4687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4688 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4689 @end deftypefn
4690
4691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMPTY_RECORD_P (const_tree @var{type})
4692 This target hook returns true if the type is an empty record. The default
4693 is to return @code{false}.
4694 @end deftypefn
4695
4696 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_WARN_PARAMETER_PASSING_ABI (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, tree @var{type})
4697 This target hook warns about the change in empty class parameter passing
4698 ABI.
4699 @end deftypefn
4700
4701 @node Caller Saves
4702 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4703
4704 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4705 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4706 must live across calls.
4707
4708 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4709 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4710 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4711 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4712 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4713 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4714 @end defmac
4715
4716 @node Function Entry
4717 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4718 @cindex function entry and exit
4719 @cindex prologue
4720 @cindex epilogue
4721
4722 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4723 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4724
4725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_PRINT_PATCHABLE_FUNCTION_ENTRY (FILE *@var{file}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{patch_area_size}, bool @var{record_p})
4726 Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of
4727 @var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions. If the target supports named
4728 sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current
4729 location in the table of patchable functions. The default implementation
4730 of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named
4731 @code{__patchable_function_entries}.
4732 @end deftypefn
4733
4734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4735 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4736 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4737 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4738 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4739 local variables. @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler
4740 code should be output.
4741
4742 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4743 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4744
4745 @findex regs_ever_live
4746 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4747 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4748 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4749 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4750 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4751 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4752
4753 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4754 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4755 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4756 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4757 registers are used in the function.
4758
4759 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4760 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4761 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4762 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4763 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4764 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4765 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4766
4767 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4768 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4769 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4770 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4771 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4772 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4773 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4774 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4775 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4776 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4777 @end deftypefn
4778
4779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4780 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4781 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4782 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4783 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4784 @end deftypefn
4785
4786 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4787 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4788 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4789 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4790 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4791 @end deftypefn
4792
4793 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4794 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4795 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4796 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4797 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4798 same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4799 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4800 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4801
4802 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4803 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4804 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4805 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4806
4807 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4808 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4809 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4810 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4811 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4812 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4813
4814 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4815 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4816 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4817 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4818 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4819 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4820
4821 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4822 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4823 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4824 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4825
4826 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4827 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4828 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4829 number of arguments.
4830
4831 @findex pops_args
4832 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4833 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4834 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4835 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4836 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4837 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4838 @end deftypefn
4839
4840 @itemize @bullet
4841 @item
4842 @findex pretend_args_size
4843 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4844 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4845 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4846 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4847 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4848 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4849 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4850 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4851 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4852 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4853
4854 @item
4855 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4856 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4857 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4858 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4859 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4860 a save area.
4861
4862 @item
4863 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4864 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4865 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4866 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4867
4868 @item
4869 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4870 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4871 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4872 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4873 @end itemize
4874
4875 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4876 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4877 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4878 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4879 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4880 default is 0.
4881
4882 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4883 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4884 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4885 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4886 @end defmac
4887
4888 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4889 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4890 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4891 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4892 @end defmac
4893
4894 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4895 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4896 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4897 on entry to an exception edge.
4898 @end defmac
4899
4900 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4901 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4902 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4903 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4904 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4905 the real function.
4906
4907 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4908 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4909 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4910 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4911 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4912 all other incoming arguments.
4913
4914 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4915 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4916 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4917
4918 @smallexample
4919 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4920 @end smallexample
4921
4922 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4923 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4924 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4925 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4926
4927 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4928 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4929 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4930 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4931
4932 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4933 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4934 some targets, but probably not.
4935
4936 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4937 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4938 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4939 not support varargs.
4940 @end deftypefn
4941
4942 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4943 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4944 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4945 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4946 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4947 previously exposed.
4948 @end deftypefn
4949
4950 @node Profiling
4951 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4952 @cindex profiling, code generation
4953
4954 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4955
4956 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4957 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4958 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4959
4960 @findex mcount
4961 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4962 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4963 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4964 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4965
4966 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4967 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4968 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4969 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4970 @end defmac
4971
4972 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4973 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4974 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4975 not support profiling.
4976 @end defmac
4977
4978 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4979 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4980 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4981 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4982 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4983 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4984 @end defmac
4985
4986 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4987 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4988 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4989 @end defmac
4990
4991 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4992 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4993 @end deftypefn
4994
4995 @node Tail Calls
4996 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4997 @cindex tail calls
4998
4999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
5000 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
5001 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
5002 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
5003
5004 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
5005 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
5006 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
5007 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern cannot fail, or fall over to a
5008 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
5009 may vary greatly between different architectures.
5010 @end deftypefn
5011
5012 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
5013 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
5014 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
5015 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
5016 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
5017 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
5018 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
5019 @end deftypefn
5020
5021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
5022 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
5023 @end deftypefn
5024
5025 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
5026 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
5027 @end deftypefn
5028
5029 @node Shrink-wrapping separate components
5030 @subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
5031 @cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
5032
5033 The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
5034 saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
5035 stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
5036 up the static chain, etc.
5037
5038 On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
5039 thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
5040 referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
5041 independent parts of GCC.
5042
5043 Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
5044 shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
5045 teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
5046 paths where this would unnecessary.
5047
5048 What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
5049 code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
5050 @code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
5051 and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
5052 generic code.
5053
5054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
5055 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
5056 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
5057 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
5058 shrink-wrapping.
5059 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
5060 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
5061 @end deftypefn
5062
5063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
5064 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
5065 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
5066 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
5067 @end deftypefn
5068
5069 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
5070 This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
5071 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
5072 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
5073 epilogue instead.
5074 @end deftypefn
5075
5076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5077 Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5078 @end deftypefn
5079
5080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5081 Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5082 @end deftypefn
5083
5084 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5085 Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
5086 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
5087 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
5088 will be deleted after this call.
5089 @end deftypefn
5090
5091 @node Stack Smashing Protection
5092 @subsection Stack smashing protection
5093 @cindex stack smashing protection
5094
5095 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
5096 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
5097 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
5098 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5099 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5100 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5101
5102 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5103 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5104 @end deftypefn
5105
5106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5107 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5108 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5109 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5110
5111 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5112 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5113 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5114 @end deftypefn
5115
5116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
5117 Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.
5118 @end deftypefn
5119
5120 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5121 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5122 @end deftypefn
5123
5124 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {vec<const char *>} TARGET_GET_VALID_OPTION_VALUES (int @var{option_code}, const char *@var{prefix})
5125 The hook is used for options that have a non-trivial list of possible option values. OPTION_CODE is option code of opt_code enum type. PREFIX is used for bash completion and allows an implementation to return more specific completion based on the prefix. All string values should be allocated from heap memory and consumers should release them. The result will be pruned to cases with PREFIX if not NULL.
5126 @end deftypefn
5127
5128 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
5129 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
5130 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
5131
5132 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
5133 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
5134 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
5135 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
5136 linker (e.g.@: stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
5137 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
5138 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
5139 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
5140 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
5141 @end deftypevr
5142
5143 @node Varargs
5144 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5145 @cindex varargs implementation
5146
5147 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5148 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5149 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5150 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5151 conditionals to include it.
5152
5153 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5154 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5155 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5156 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5157 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5158 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5159
5160 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5161 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5162 below.
5163
5164 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5165 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5166 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5167 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5168 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5169
5170 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5171 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5172 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5173 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5174
5175 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5176 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5177 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5178 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5179 to use them for its own purposes.
5180 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5181 @c 10feb93
5182 @end defmac
5183
5184 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5185 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5186 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5187 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5188 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5189 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5190 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5191 of the current function.
5192 @end defmac
5193
5194 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5195 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5196 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5197 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5198 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5199 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5200
5201 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5202 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5203 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5204
5205 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5206 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5207 @end defmac
5208
5209 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5210
5211 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5212 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5213 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5214 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5215 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5216 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5217 @end deftypefn
5218
5219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, const function_arg_info @var{&arg}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5220 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5221 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5222 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5223 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5224 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5225 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5226 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5227
5228 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5229 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5230 named arguments. The argument @var{arg} describes the last of these named
5231 arguments.
5232
5233 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5234 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5235 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5236 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5237 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5238 frame.
5239
5240 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5241 compile time without knowing their data types,
5242 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5243 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5244 for all data types.
5245
5246 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5247 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5248 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5249 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5250 not generate any instructions in this case.
5251 @end deftypefn
5252
5253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5254 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5255 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5256
5257 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5258 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5259 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5260 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5261 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5262 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5263 except the last are treated as named.
5264
5265 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5266 @end deftypefn
5267
5268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5269 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5270 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5271 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5272 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5273 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5274 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5275 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5276 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5277 registers if a target needs it.
5278 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5279 passed instead of an argument register.
5280 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5281 @end deftypefn
5282
5283 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5284 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5285 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5286 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5287 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5288 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5289 @end deftypefn
5290
5291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5292 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5293 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5294 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5295 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5296 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5297 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5298 @end deftypefn
5299
5300 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5301 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5302 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5303 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5304 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5305 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5306 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5307 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5308 @end deftypefn
5309
5310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5311 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5312 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5313 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5314 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5315 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5316 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5317 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5318 @end deftypefn
5319
5320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5321 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5322 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5323 loaded bounds.
5324 @end deftypefn
5325
5326 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5327 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5328 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5329 @end deftypefn
5330
5331 @node Trampolines
5332 @section Support for Nested Functions
5333 @cindex support for nested functions
5334 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5335 @cindex descriptors for nested functions
5336 @cindex nested functions, support for
5337
5338 Taking the address of a nested function requires special compiler
5339 handling to ensure that the static chain register is loaded when
5340 the function is invoked via an indirect call.
5341
5342 GCC has traditionally supported nested functions by creating an
5343 executable @dfn{trampoline} at run time when the address of a nested
5344 function is taken. This is a small piece of code which normally
5345 resides on the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.
5346 The trampoline loads the static chain register and then jumps to the
5347 real address of the nested function.
5348
5349 The use of trampolines requires an executable stack, which is a
5350 security risk. To avoid this problem, GCC also supports another
5351 strategy: using descriptors for nested functions. Under this model,
5352 taking the address of a nested function results in a pointer to a
5353 non-executable function descriptor object. Initializing the static chain
5354 from the descriptor is handled at indirect call sites.
5355
5356 On some targets, including HPPA and IA-64, function descriptors may be
5357 mandated by the ABI or be otherwise handled in a target-specific way
5358 by the back end in its code generation strategy for indirect calls.
5359 GCC also provides its own generic descriptor implementation to support the
5360 @option{-fno-trampolines} option. In this case runtime detection of
5361 function descriptors at indirect call sites relies on descriptor
5362 pointers being tagged with a bit that is never set in bare function
5363 addresses. Since GCC's generic function descriptors are
5364 not ABI-compliant, this option is typically used only on a
5365 per-language basis (notably by Ada) or when it can otherwise be
5366 applied to the whole program.
5367
5368 Define the following hook if your backend either implements ABI-specified
5369 descriptor support, or can use GCC's generic descriptor implementation
5370 for nested functions.
5371
5372 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5373 If the target can use GCC's generic descriptor mechanism for nested
5374 functions, define this hook to a power of 2 representing an unused bit
5375 in function pointers which can be used to differentiate descriptors at
5376 run time. This value gives the number of bytes by which descriptor
5377 pointers are misaligned compared to function pointers. For example, on
5378 targets that require functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary, a
5379 value of either 1 or 2 is appropriate unless the architecture already
5380 reserves the bit for another purpose, such as on ARM.
5381
5382 Define this hook to 0 if the target implements ABI support for
5383 function descriptors in its standard calling sequence, like for example
5384 HPPA or IA-64.
5385
5386 Using descriptors for nested functions
5387 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5388 it to be made executable.
5389 @end deftypevr
5390
5391 The following macros tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and
5392 initialize an executable trampoline. You can also use this interface
5393 if your back end needs to create ABI-specified non-executable descriptors; in
5394 this case the "trampoline" created is the descriptor containing data only.
5395
5396 The instructions in an executable trampoline must do two things: load
5397 a constant address into the static chain register, and jump to the real
5398 address of the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k,
5399 this requires two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the
5400 two addresses exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.
5401 On RISC machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a
5402 register in two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate
5403 immediate operands.
5404
5405 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5406 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5407 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5408 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5409 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5410 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5411 separately.
5412
5413 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5414 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5415 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5416 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5417 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5418
5419 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5420 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5421 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5422 to generate it on the spot.
5423 @end deftypefn
5424
5425 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5426 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5427 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5428 @end defmac
5429
5430 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5431 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5432 @end defmac
5433
5434 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5435 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5436
5437 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5438 is used for aligning trampolines.
5439 @end defmac
5440
5441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5442 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5443 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5444 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5445 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5446 when it is called.
5447
5448 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5449 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5450 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5451 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5452 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5453 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5454
5455 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5456 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5457 initializing the trampoline proper.
5458 @end deftypefn
5459
5460 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5461 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5462 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5463 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5464 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5465 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5466 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5467 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5468 @end deftypefn
5469
5470 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5471 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5472 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5473 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5474
5475 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5476 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5477 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5478 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5479 latter makes initialization faster.
5480
5481 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5482 the following macro.
5483
5484 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5485 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5486 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5487 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5488 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5489 @end defmac
5490
5491 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5492 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5493 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5494 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5495 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5496
5497 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5498 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5499 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5500 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5501 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5502
5503 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5504 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5505 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5506 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5507 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5508 special assembler code.
5509 @end defmac
5510
5511 @node Library Calls
5512 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5513 @cindex library subroutine names
5514 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5515
5516 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5517 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5518
5519 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5520 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5521 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5522 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5523 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5524 @end defmac
5525
5526 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5527 @findex init_one_libfunc
5528 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5529 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5530 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5531 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5532 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5533 library routines.
5534
5535 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5536 @end deftypefn
5537
5538 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5539 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5540 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5541 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5542 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5543 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5544 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5545 @end deftypevr
5546
5547 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5548 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5549 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5550 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5551 return a tristate.
5552
5553 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5554 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5555 don't need to define this macro.
5556 @end defmac
5557
5558 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5559 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5560 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5561 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5562 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5563 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5564 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5565 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5566 @end defmac
5567
5568 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5569 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5570 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5571 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5572 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5573 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5574 @end defmac
5575
5576 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5577 @findex matherr
5578 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5579 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5580 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5581 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5582 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5583 system.
5584
5585 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5586 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5587 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5588 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5589 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5590 @end defmac
5591
5592 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5593 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5594 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5595 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5596 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5597 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5598 @end defmac
5599
5600 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5601 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5602 @var{fn_class} is present in the target C library.
5603 @end deftypefn
5604
5605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FAST_FUNCTION (int @var{fcode})
5606 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5607 @code{(enum function_class)}@var{fcode} has a fast implementation.
5608 @end deftypefn
5609
5610 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5611 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5612 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5613 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5614 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5615 the NeXT runtime installed.
5616
5617 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5618 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5619 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5620
5621 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5622 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5623 @end defmac
5624
5625 @node Addressing Modes
5626 @section Addressing Modes
5627 @cindex addressing modes
5628
5629 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5630 This is about addressing modes.
5631
5632 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5633 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5634 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5635 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5636 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5637 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5638 @end defmac
5639
5640 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5641 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5642 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5643 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5644 the size of the memory operand.
5645 @end defmac
5646
5647 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5648 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5649 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5650 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5651 @end defmac
5652
5653 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5654 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5655 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5656 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5657 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5658 constant addresses are supported.
5659 @end defmac
5660
5661 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5662 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5663 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5664 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5665 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5666 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5667 @end defmac
5668
5669 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5670 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5671 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5672 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5673 accept.
5674 @end defmac
5675
5676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5677 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5678 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5679
5680 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5681 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5682 desired by the caller.
5683
5684 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5685 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5686 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5687 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5688 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5689 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5690 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5691 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5692
5693 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5694 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5695 register is required.
5696
5697 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5698 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5699 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5700 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5701 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5702
5703 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5704 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5705 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5706 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5707 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5708
5709 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5710 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5711 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5712 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5713 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5714 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5715 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5716 Format}.
5717
5718 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5719 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5720 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5721 has this syntax:
5722
5723 @example
5724 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5725 @end example
5726
5727 @noindent
5728 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5729 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5730
5731 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5732 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5733 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5734 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5735 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5736
5737 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5738 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5739 @end deftypefn
5740
5741 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5742 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5743 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5744 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5745 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5746 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5747 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5748 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5749 @code{'m'} constraint.
5750 @end defmac
5751
5752 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5753 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5754 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5755 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5756 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5757
5758 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5759 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5760
5761 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5762 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5763 @end defmac
5764
5765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5766 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5767 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5768 address.
5769
5770 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5771 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5772 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5773 @var{x}.
5774
5775 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5776 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5777 should return the new @var{x}.
5778
5779 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5780 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5781 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5782 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5783 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5784 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5785 strategy can generate better code.
5786 @end deftypefn
5787
5788 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5789 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5790 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5791 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5792 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5793 performance reasons.
5794
5795 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5796 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5797 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5798 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5799 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5800 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5801 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5802 be shared.
5803
5804 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5805 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5806 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5807 of reload internals.
5808
5809 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5810 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5811 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5812
5813 @findex push_reload
5814 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5815 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5816 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5817
5818 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5819 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5820 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5821 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5822 @code{push_reload}.
5823
5824 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5825 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5826 the address has become legitimate.
5827
5828 @findex copy_rtx
5829 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5830 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5831 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5832 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5833 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5834 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5835 @end defmac
5836
5837 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5838 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5839 space @var{addrspace} can have
5840 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5841 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5842 but not others.
5843
5844 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5845 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5846 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5847 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5848
5849 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5850
5851 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5852 @end deftypefn
5853
5854 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5855 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5856 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5857 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5858
5859 The default definition returns true.
5860 @end deftypefn
5861
5862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5863 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5864 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5865 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5866 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5867 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5868 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5869 into their original form.
5870 @end deftypefn
5871
5872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5873 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5874 debug sections.
5875 @end deftypefn
5876
5877 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5878 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5879 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5880 of @var{x}.
5881
5882 The default version of this hook returns false.
5883
5884 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5885 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5886 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5887 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5888 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5889 @end deftypefn
5890
5891 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5892 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5893 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5894 of @var{x}.
5895
5896 The default version returns false for all constants.
5897 @end deftypefn
5898
5899 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5900 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5901 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5902
5903 The default version returns true for all decls.
5904 @end deftypefn
5905
5906 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5907 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5908 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5909 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5910 @end deftypefn
5911
5912 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5913 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5914 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5915 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5916 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5917
5918 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5919 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5920 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5921 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5922 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5923 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5924 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5925 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5926 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5927 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5928 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5929
5930 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5931 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5932 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5933 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5934 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5935 described above.
5936 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5937 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5938 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5939 @end deftypefn
5940
5941 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5942 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5943 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5944 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5945 @end deftypefn
5946
5947 @deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_uint64 TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
5948 This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for accesses to
5949 vectors of type @var{type} in vectorized code. This might be less than
5950 or greater than the ABI-defined value returned by
5951 @code{TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT}. It can be equal to the alignment of
5952 a single element, in which case the vectorizer will not try to optimize
5953 for alignment.
5954
5955 The default hook returns @code{TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type})}, which is
5956 correct for most targets.
5957 @end deftypefn
5958
5959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5960 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.
5961 @end deftypefn
5962
5963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{output}, rtx @var{in0}, rtx @var{in1}, const vec_perm_indices @var{&sel})
5964 This hook is used to test whether the target can permute up to two
5965 vectors of mode @var{mode} using the permutation vector @code{sel}, and
5966 also to emit such a permutation. In the former case @var{in0}, @var{in1}
5967 and @var{out} are all null. In the latter case @var{in0} and @var{in1} are
5968 the source vectors and @var{out} is the destination vector; all three are
5969 registers of mode @var{mode}. @var{in1} is the same as @var{in0} if
5970 @var{sel} describes a permutation on one vector instead of two.
5971
5972 Return true if the operation is possible, emitting instructions for it
5973 if rtxes are provided.
5974
5975 @cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
5976 If the hook returns false for a mode with multibyte elements, GCC will
5977 try the equivalent byte operation. If that also fails, it will try forcing
5978 the selector into a register and using the @var{vec_perm@var{mode}}
5979 instruction pattern. There is no need for the hook to handle these two
5980 implementation approaches itself.
5981 @end deftypefn
5982
5983 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5984 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5985 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5986 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5987 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5988 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5989 @end deftypefn
5990
5991 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5992 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5993 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5994 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5995 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5996 @end deftypefn
5997
5998 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5999 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
6000 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
6001 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
6002 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
6003 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
6004 @end deftypefn
6005
6006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (scalar_mode @var{mode})
6007 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
6008 mode @var{mode}. The default is
6009 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
6010 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
6011 @end deftypefn
6012
6013 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_SPLIT_REDUCTION (machine_mode)
6014 This hook should return the preferred mode to split the final reduction
6015 step on @var{mode} to. The reduction is then carried out reducing upper
6016 against lower halves of vectors recursively until the specified mode is
6017 reached. The default is @var{mode} which means no splitting.
6018 @end deftypefn
6019
6020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_MODES (vector_modes *@var{modes}, bool @var{all})
6021 If using the mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}
6022 is not the only approach worth considering, this hook should add one mode to
6023 @var{modes} for each useful alternative approach. These modes are then
6024 passed to @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_RELATED_MODE} to obtain the vector mode
6025 for a given element mode.
6026
6027 The modes returned in @var{modes} should use the smallest element mode
6028 possible for the vectorization approach that they represent, preferring
6029 integer modes over floating-poing modes in the event of a tie. The first
6030 mode should be the @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} for its
6031 element mode.
6032
6033 If @var{all} is true, add suitable vector modes even when they are generally
6034 not expected to be worthwhile.
6035
6036 The hook returns a bitmask of flags that control how the modes in
6037 @var{modes} are used. The flags are:
6038 @table @code
6039 @item VECT_COMPARE_COSTS
6040 Tells the loop vectorizer to try all the provided modes and pick the one
6041 with the lowest cost. By default the vectorizer will choose the first
6042 mode that works.
6043 @end table
6044
6045 The hook does not need to do anything if the vector returned by
6046 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is the only one relevant
6047 for autovectorization. The default implementation adds no modes and
6048 returns 0.
6049 @end deftypefn
6050
6051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_RELATED_MODE (machine_mode @var{vector_mode}, scalar_mode @var{element_mode}, poly_uint64 @var{nunits})
6052 If a piece of code is using vector mode @var{vector_mode} and also wants
6053 to operate on elements of mode @var{element_mode}, return the vector mode
6054 it should use for those elements. If @var{nunits} is nonzero, ensure that
6055 the mode has exactly @var{nunits} elements, otherwise pick whichever vector
6056 size pairs the most naturally with @var{vector_mode}. Return an empty
6057 @code{opt_machine_mode} if there is no supported vector mode with the
6058 required properties.
6059
6060 There is no prescribed way of handling the case in which @var{nunits}
6061 is zero. One common choice is to pick a vector mode with the same size
6062 as @var{vector_mode}; this is the natural choice if the target has a
6063 fixed vector size. Another option is to choose a vector mode with the
6064 same number of elements as @var{vector_mode}; this is the natural choice
6065 if the target has a fixed number of elements. Alternatively, the hook
6066 might choose a middle ground, such as trying to keep the number of
6067 elements as similar as possible while applying maximum and minimum
6068 vector sizes.
6069
6070 The default implementation uses @code{mode_for_vector} to find the
6071 requested mode, returning a mode with the same size as @var{vector_mode}
6072 when @var{nunits} is zero. This is the correct behavior for most targets.
6073 @end deftypefn
6074
6075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
6076 Return the mode to use for a vector mask that holds one boolean
6077 result for each element of vector mode @var{mode}. The returned mask mode
6078 can be a vector of integers (class @code{MODE_VECTOR_INT}), a vector of
6079 booleans (class @code{MODE_VECTOR_BOOL}) or a scalar integer (class
6080 @code{MODE_INT}). Return an empty @code{opt_machine_mode} if no such
6081 mask mode exists.
6082
6083 The default implementation returns a @code{MODE_VECTOR_INT} with the
6084 same size and number of elements as @var{mode}, if such a mode exists.
6085 @end deftypefn
6086
6087 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_EMPTY_MASK_IS_EXPENSIVE (unsigned @var{ifn})
6088 This hook returns true if masked internal function @var{ifn} (really of
6089 type @code{internal_fn}) should be considered expensive when the mask is
6090 all zeros. GCC can then try to branch around the instruction instead.
6091 @end deftypefn
6092
6093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (class loop *@var{loop_info})
6094 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
6095 @end deftypefn
6096
6097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (class vec_info *@var{}, void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, class _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
6098 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
6099 @end deftypefn
6100
6101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
6102 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
6103 @end deftypefn
6104
6105 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
6106 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
6107 @end deftypefn
6108
6109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
6110 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
6111 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
6112 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
6113 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
6114 loads.
6115 @end deftypefn
6116
6117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
6118 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
6119 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
6120 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
6121 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
6122 stores.
6123 @end deftypefn
6124
6125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
6126 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
6127 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
6128 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
6129 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
6130 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
6131 @end deftypefn
6132
6133 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6134 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
6135 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
6136 @end deftypefn
6137
6138 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6139 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
6140 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
6141 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
6142 to use it.
6143 @end deftypefn
6144
6145 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
6146 Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
6147 @end deftypefn
6148
6149 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_OMP_DEVICE_KIND_ARCH_ISA (enum omp_device_kind_arch_isa @var{trait}, const char *@var{name})
6150 Return 1 if @var{trait} @var{name} is present in the OpenMP context's
6151 device trait set, return 0 if not present in any OpenMP context in the
6152 whole translation unit, or -1 if not present in the current OpenMP context
6153 but might be present in another OpenMP context in the same TU.
6154 @end deftypefn
6155
6156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level}, unsigned @var{used})
6157 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
6158 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
6159 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
6160 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine it is the
6161 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
6162 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
6163 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
6164 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
6165 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
6166 provide dimensions larger than 1.
6167 @end deftypefn
6168
6169 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
6170 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
6171 or zero if unbounded.
6172 @end deftypefn
6173
6174 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
6175 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
6176 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
6177 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
6178 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
6179 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
6180 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
6181 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
6182 @end deftypefn
6183
6184 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
6185 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
6186 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
6187 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
6188 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
6189 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
6190 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
6191 @end deftypefn
6192
6193 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PREFERRED_ELSE_VALUE (unsigned @var{ifn}, tree @var{type}, unsigned @var{nops}, tree *@var{ops})
6194 This hook returns the target's preferred final argument for a call
6195 to conditional internal function @var{ifn} (really of type
6196 @code{internal_fn}). @var{type} specifies the return type of the
6197 function and @var{ops} are the operands to the conditional operation,
6198 of which there are @var{nops}.
6199
6200 For example, if @var{ifn} is @code{IFN_COND_ADD}, the hook returns
6201 a value of type @var{type} that should be used when @samp{@var{ops}[0]}
6202 and @samp{@var{ops}[1]} are conditionally added together.
6203
6204 This hook is only relevant if the target supports conditional patterns
6205 like @code{cond_add@var{m}}. The default implementation returns a zero
6206 constant of type @var{type}.
6207 @end deftypefn
6208
6209 @node Anchored Addresses
6210 @section Anchored Addresses
6211 @cindex anchored addresses
6212 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
6213
6214 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
6215 For example, if we have:
6216
6217 @smallexample
6218 static int a, b, c;
6219 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
6220 @end smallexample
6221
6222 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
6223 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
6224 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
6225 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
6226 be something like:
6227
6228 @smallexample
6229 int foo (void)
6230 @{
6231 register int *xr = &x;
6232 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
6233 @}
6234 @end smallexample
6235
6236 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
6237 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
6238
6239 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
6240 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
6241 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
6242 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
6243
6244 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6245 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
6246 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
6247 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
6248 for every mode. The default value is 0.
6249 @end deftypevr
6250
6251 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6252 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
6253 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
6254 value is 0.
6255 @end deftypevr
6256
6257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
6258 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
6259 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
6260 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
6261 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
6262
6263 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
6264 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
6265 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
6266 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
6267 @end deftypefn
6268
6269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
6270 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
6271 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
6272 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
6273
6274 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
6275 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
6276 or target-specific sections.
6277 @end deftypefn
6278
6279 @node Condition Code
6280 @section Condition Code Status
6281 @cindex condition code status
6282
6283 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
6284 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
6285
6286 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
6287 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
6288 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
6289 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
6290 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
6291 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
6292 most RISC machines.
6293
6294 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
6295 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
6296 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
6297 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
6298 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
6299 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
6300
6301 These restrictions can prevent important
6302 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
6303 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
6304 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
6305 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6306 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6307
6308 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6309 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
6310 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
6311 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6312 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6313 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6314 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6315
6316 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6317 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6318 interested in most macros in this section.
6319
6320 @menu
6321 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6322 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
6323 @end menu
6324
6325 @node CC0 Condition Codes
6326 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6327 @findex cc0
6328
6329 @findex cc_status
6330 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6331 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6332 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6333 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6334 currently based, and several standard flags.
6335
6336 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6337 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6338 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6339
6340 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6341 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6342 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6343
6344 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6345 @end defmac
6346
6347 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6348 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6349 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6350 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6351 define this macro to initialize it.
6352
6353 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6354 @end defmac
6355
6356 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6357 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6358 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6359 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6360 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6361 set @code{(cc0)}.
6362
6363 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6364
6365 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6366 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6367 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6368 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6369 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6370 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6371 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6372 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6373 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6374 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6375 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6376 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6377 condition code value.
6378
6379 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6380 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6381 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6382 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6383 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6384 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6385 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6386
6387 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6388 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6389 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6390 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6391 @end defmac
6392
6393 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6394 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6395 @findex CCmode
6396 @findex MODE_CC
6397
6398 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6399 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6400 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6401 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6402 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6403 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6404 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6405 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6406 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6407 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g.@: a signed or an
6408 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6409
6410 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6411 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6412 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6413 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6414 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6415 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6416 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6417
6418 @smallexample
6419 (define_insn ""
6420 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6421 (compare:CCNZ
6422 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6423 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6424 (const_int 0)))]
6425 ""
6426 "@dots{}")
6427 @end smallexample
6428
6429 @noindent
6430 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6431 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6432
6433 @smallexample
6434 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6435 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6436 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6437 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6438 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6439 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6440 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6441 @end smallexample
6442
6443 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6444 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6445 this section.
6446
6447 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6448 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6449 @end defmac
6450
6451 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6452 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6453 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6454 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6455 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6456
6457 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6458 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6459 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6460 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6461 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6462 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6463 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6464
6465 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6466 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6467 @file{md} file.
6468
6469 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6470 comparison code or operands.
6471 @end deftypefn
6472
6473 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6474 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6475 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6476 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6477 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6478
6479 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6480 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6481 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6482 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6483
6484 @smallexample
6485 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6486 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6487 @end smallexample
6488 @end defmac
6489
6490 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6491 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6492 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6493 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6494 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6495 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6496 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6497 like:
6498
6499 @smallexample
6500 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6501 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6502 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6503 @end smallexample
6504 @end defmac
6505
6506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6507 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6508 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6509 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6510 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6511 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6512 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6513 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6514 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6515 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6516 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6517
6518 The default version of this hook returns false.
6519 @end deftypefn
6520
6521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6522 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6523 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6524 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6525 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6526 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6527 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6528
6529 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6530 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6531 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6532 @end deftypefn
6533
6534 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6535 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the
6536 post-reload comparison elimination pass, or the delay slot filler pass,
6537 then this value should be set appropriately.
6538 @end deftypevr
6539
6540 @node Costs
6541 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6542 @cindex costs of instructions
6543 @cindex relative costs
6544 @cindex speed of instructions
6545
6546 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6547 on the target machine.
6548
6549 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6550 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6551 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6552 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6553 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6554 that.
6555
6556 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6557 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6558 registers if they are not general registers.
6559
6560 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6561 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6562 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6563 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6564 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6565 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6566
6567 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6568 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6569 @end defmac
6570
6571 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6572 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6573 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6574 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6575 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6576 that.
6577
6578 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6579 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6580 registers if they are not general registers.
6581
6582 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6583 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6584 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6585 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6586 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6587 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6588
6589 The default version of this function returns 2.
6590 @end deftypefn
6591
6592 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6593 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6594 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6595 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6596 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6597 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6598 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6599
6600 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6601 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6602 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6603 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6604 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6605 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6606
6607 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6608 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6609 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6610 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6611 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6612 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6613 are the same as to this macro.
6614
6615 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6616 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6617 @end defmac
6618
6619 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6620 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6621 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6622 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6623 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6624 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6625 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6626
6627 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6628 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6629 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6630 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6631 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6632 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6633
6634 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6635 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6636 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6637 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6638 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6639 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6640 are the same as to this target hook.
6641 @end deftypefn
6642
6643 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6644 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6645 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6646 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6647 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6648 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6649 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6650 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6651 @end defmac
6652
6653 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6654 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6655 ordinarily expect.
6656
6657 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6658 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6659 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6660 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6661 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6662 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6663
6664 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6665 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6666 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6667 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6668 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6669 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6670 @end defmac
6671
6672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned int @var{align})
6673 This hook returns true if memory accesses described by the
6674 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6675 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap handler.
6676 This hook is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e.@: when
6677 @code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
6678
6679 When this hook returns true, the compiler will act as if
6680 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were true when generating code for block
6681 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6682 Therefore, do not make this hook return true if unaligned accesses only
6683 add a cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6684
6685 The hook must return true whenever @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is true.
6686 The default implementation returns @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT}.
6687 @end deftypefn
6688
6689 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6690 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6691 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6692 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6693 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6694
6695 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6696 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6697 the number of such sequences.
6698
6699 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6700 optimized for speed rather than size.
6701
6702 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6703 @end defmac
6704
6705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6706 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6707 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6708 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6709 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6710 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6711 @code{cpymem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6712 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6713
6714 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6715 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6716 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6717 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6718 units.
6719
6720 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6721 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6722 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6723 under consideration.
6724
6725 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6726 optimized for speed rather than size.
6727
6728 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6729 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6730 @code{cpymem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{cpymem} or
6731 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6732 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6733 the body of the memory operation.
6734
6735 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6736 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6737 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6738 @end deftypefn
6739
6740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6741 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6742 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6743 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6744 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6745 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6746 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6747 negative number from this hook.
6748 @end deftypefn
6749
6750 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6751 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6752 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6753 @end defmac
6754
6755 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6756 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6757 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6758 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6759 @end defmac
6760
6761 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6762 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6763 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6764 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6765 @end defmac
6766
6767 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6768 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6769 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6770 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6771 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6772
6773 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6774 optimized for speed rather than size.
6775
6776 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6777 @end defmac
6778
6779 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6780 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6781 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6782 a block set insn or a library call.
6783 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6784 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6785
6786 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6787 optimized for speed rather than size.
6788
6789 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6790 @end defmac
6791
6792 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6793 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6794 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6795 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6796 @end defmac
6797
6798 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6799 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6800 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6801 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6802 @end defmac
6803
6804 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6805 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6806 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6807 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6808 @end defmac
6809
6810 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6811 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6812 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6813 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6814 @end defmac
6815
6816 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6817 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6818 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6819 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6820 @end defmac
6821
6822 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6823 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6824 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6825 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6826 @end defmac
6827
6828 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6829 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6830 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6831 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6832 @end defmac
6833
6834 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6835 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6836 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6837 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6838 @end defmac
6839
6840 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6841 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6842 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6843 @end defmac
6844
6845 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6846 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6847 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6848 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6849 @end defmac
6850
6851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6852 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6853 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6854 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6855 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6856 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6857
6858 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6859 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6860 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6861
6862 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6863 @end deftypefn
6864
6865 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6866 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6867
6868 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6869 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6870 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6871 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6872 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6873 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6874 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6875
6876 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6877 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6878
6879 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6880 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6881 instructions.
6882
6883 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6884 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6885 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6886 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6887 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6888
6889 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6890 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6891 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6892
6893 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6894 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6895 @end deftypefn
6896
6897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6898 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6899 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6900 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6901
6902 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6903 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6904 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6905 all addresses will have equal costs.
6906
6907 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6908 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6909 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6910
6911 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6912 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6913 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6914 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6915 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6916 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6917 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6918 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6919
6920 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6921
6922 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6923 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6924 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6925 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6926 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6927 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6928 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6929 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6930 @end deftypefn
6931
6932 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_INSN_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, bool @var{speed})
6933 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL instructions.
6934
6935 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6936 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6937 instructions.
6938
6939 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6940 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6941 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6942 @end deftypefn
6943
6944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6945 This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6946 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6947 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6948 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6949 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6950 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6951 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6952 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6953 is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6954
6955 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6956 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6957 were true.
6958
6959 The default implementation of this hook uses the
6960 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6961 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6962 @end deftypefn
6963
6964 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info})
6965 This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good
6966 candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in
6967 @code{if_info}.
6968 @end deftypefn
6969
6970 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6971 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6972 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6973 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6974 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6975 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6976 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6977 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6978 @end deftypefn
6979
6980 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ESTIMATED_POLY_VALUE (poly_int64 @var{val})
6981 Return an estimate of the runtime value of @var{val}, for use in
6982 things like cost calculations or profiling frequencies. The default
6983 implementation returns the lowest possible value of @var{val}.
6984 @end deftypefn
6985
6986 @node Scheduling
6987 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6988
6989 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6990 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6991 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6992 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6993
6994 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6995 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6996 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6997 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6998 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6999 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
7000 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
7001 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
7002 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
7003 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
7004 @end deftypefn
7005
7006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
7007 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
7008 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
7009 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
7010 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
7011 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
7012 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
7013 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
7014 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
7015 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7016 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
7017 was scheduled.
7018 @end deftypefn
7019
7020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
7021 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
7022 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
7023 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
7024 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
7025 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
7026 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
7027 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
7028 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
7029 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
7030 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
7031 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
7032 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
7033 @end deftypefn
7034
7035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
7036 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
7037 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
7038 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
7039 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
7040 scheduling priorities of insns.
7041 @end deftypefn
7042
7043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
7044 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
7045 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
7046 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
7047 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
7048 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7049 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
7050 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
7051 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
7052 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
7053 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
7054 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
7055 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
7056 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
7057 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
7058 @end deftypefn
7059
7060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
7061 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
7062 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
7063 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
7064 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
7065 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
7066 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
7067 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
7068 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
7069 @end deftypefn
7070
7071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
7072 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
7073 @end deftypefn
7074
7075 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
7076 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
7077 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
7078 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
7079 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
7080 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
7081 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
7082 @end deftypefn
7083
7084 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
7085 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
7086 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
7087 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
7088 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
7089 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
7090 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
7091 calculated.
7092 @end deftypefn
7093
7094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
7095 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
7096 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
7097 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
7098 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7099 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
7100 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
7101 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
7102 @end deftypefn
7103
7104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
7105 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
7106 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
7107 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
7108 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
7109 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7110 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7111 @end deftypefn
7112
7113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
7114 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
7115 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
7116 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7117 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
7118 @end deftypefn
7119
7120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
7121 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
7122 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
7123 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7124 @end deftypefn
7125
7126 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7127 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
7128 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
7129 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
7130 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
7131 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
7132 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
7133 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
7134 @end deftypefn
7135
7136 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7137 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
7138 @end deftypefn
7139
7140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7141 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7142 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
7143 simulated processor cycle finishes.
7144 @end deftypefn
7145
7146 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7147 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
7148 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
7149 @end deftypefn
7150
7151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
7152 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
7153 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7154 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7155 state on a single insn is not enough.
7156 @end deftypefn
7157
7158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
7159 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
7160 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7161 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7162 state on a single insn is not enough.
7163 @end deftypefn
7164
7165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
7166 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
7167 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
7168 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
7169 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
7170 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
7171 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
7172 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
7173 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
7174 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
7175 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
7176
7177 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
7178 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
7179 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
7180 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
7181 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
7182 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
7183 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
7184 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
7185 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
7186
7187 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
7188 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
7189 schedules to choose the best one.
7190
7191 The default is no multipass scheduling.
7192 @end deftypefn
7193
7194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
7195
7196 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
7197 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
7198 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
7199 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
7200 the current round of multipass scheduling.
7201 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
7202 number of cycles.
7203 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
7204 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
7205 to allow backends make correct judgements.
7206
7207 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
7208 @end deftypefn
7209
7210 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
7211 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
7212 scheduling.
7213 @end deftypefn
7214
7215 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
7216 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
7217 @end deftypefn
7218
7219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
7220 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
7221 an instruction.
7222 @end deftypefn
7223
7224 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
7225 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
7226 round of multipass scheduling.
7227 @end deftypefn
7228
7229 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
7230 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7231 @end deftypefn
7232
7233 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
7234 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7235 @end deftypefn
7236
7237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
7238 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
7239 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
7240 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
7241 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
7242 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
7243 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
7244 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
7245 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
7246 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
7247 and the current processor cycle.
7248 @end deftypefn
7249
7250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
7251 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
7252 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
7253 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
7254 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
7255 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
7256 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
7257 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
7258 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
7259 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
7260 and @code{false} otherwise.
7261
7262 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
7263 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
7264 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
7265 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
7266 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
7267 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
7268 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
7269 @end deftypefn
7270
7271 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
7272 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
7273 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
7274 per instruction data structures.
7275 @end deftypefn
7276
7277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
7278 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
7279 @end deftypefn
7280
7281 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
7282 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
7283 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
7284 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
7285 @end deftypefn
7286
7287 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7288 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
7289 @end deftypefn
7290
7291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7292 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7293 @end deftypefn
7294
7295 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7296 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7297 @end deftypefn
7298
7299 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
7300 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
7301 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
7302 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
7303 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
7304 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
7305 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
7306 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
7307 the generated speculative pattern.
7308 @end deftypefn
7309
7310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
7311 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
7312 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
7313 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
7314 @end deftypefn
7315
7316 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
7317 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
7318 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
7319 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
7320 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
7321 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
7322 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
7323 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
7324 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
7325 @end deftypefn
7326
7327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
7328 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
7329 enabled/used.
7330 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
7331 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7332 @end deftypefn
7333
7334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7335 Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually
7336 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such
7337 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the
7338 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}
7339 should not be speculated.
7340 @end deftypefn
7341
7342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7343 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7344 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7345 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
7346 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
7347 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7348 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7349 @end deftypefn
7350
7351 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7352 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7353 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7354 @end deftypefn
7355
7356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7357 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7358 in its second parameter.
7359 @end deftypefn
7360
7361 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7362 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7363 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7364 also the latencies of operations.
7365 @end deftypevr
7366
7367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7368 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7369 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7370 @end deftypefn
7371
7372 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7373 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7374 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7375 are returned via pointer parameters.
7376
7377 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7378 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7379 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7380 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7381 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7382 should be calculated and returned.
7383
7384 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7385 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7386 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7387 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7388 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7389 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7390 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7391 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7392 instructions.
7393
7394 Given below example:
7395
7396 @smallexample
7397 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7398 add r4, r4, r10
7399 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7400 sub r5, r5, r15
7401 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7402 add r4, r4, r11
7403 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7404 sub r5, r5, r16
7405 @end smallexample
7406
7407 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7408 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7409 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7410 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7411 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7412
7413 @smallexample
7414 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7415 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7416 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7417 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7418 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7419 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7420 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7421 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7422 @end smallexample
7423
7424 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7425 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7426 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7427
7428 @smallexample
7429 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7430 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7431 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7432 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7433 add r4, r4, r10
7434 sub r5, r5, r15
7435 add r4, r4, r11
7436 sub r5, r5, r16
7437 @end smallexample
7438
7439 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7440
7441 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7442 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7443
7444 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7445 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7446 @end deftypefn
7447
7448 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7449 Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7450 hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7451 @end deftypefn
7452
7453 @node Sections
7454 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7455 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7456 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7457
7458 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7459 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7460 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7461 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7462 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7463 of sections.
7464
7465 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7466 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7467 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7468 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7469 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7470 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7471 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7472
7473 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7474 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7475 to be string literals.
7476
7477 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7478 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7479 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7480 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7481
7482 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7483 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7484 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7485 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7486 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7487 reuse @code{text_section}.
7488
7489 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7490 if the target does not provide them.
7491
7492 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7493 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7494 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7495 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7496 @end defmac
7497
7498 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7499 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7500 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7501 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7502 @end defmac
7503
7504 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7505 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7506 executed functions in the program.
7507 @end defmac
7508
7509 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7510 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7511 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7512 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7513 @end defmac
7514
7515 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7516 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7517 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7518 initialized, writable small data.
7519 @end defmac
7520
7521 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7522 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7523 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7524 data.
7525 @end defmac
7526
7527 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7528 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7529 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7530 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7531 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7532 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7533 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7534 used.
7535 @end defmac
7536
7537 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7538 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7539 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7540 uninitialized, writable small data.
7541 @end defmac
7542
7543 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7544 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7545 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7546 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7547 @end defmac
7548
7549 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7550 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7551 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7552 default is @code{'T'}.
7553 @end defmac
7554
7555 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7556 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7557 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7558 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7559 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7560 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7561 @end defmac
7562
7563 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7564 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7565 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7566 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7567 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7568 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7569 @end defmac
7570
7571 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7572 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7573 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7574 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7575 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7576 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7577 @end defmac
7578
7579 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7580 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7581 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7582 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7583 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7584 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7585 @end defmac
7586
7587 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7588 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7589 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7590 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7591 @end defmac
7592
7593 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7594 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7595 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7596 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7597 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7598 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7599 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7600 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7601 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7602 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7603 @end defmac
7604
7605 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7606 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7607 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7608 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7609 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7610 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7611 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7612 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7613 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7614 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7615 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7616 @end defmac
7617
7618 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7619 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7620 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7621 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7622 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7623 @end defmac
7624
7625 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7626 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7627 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7628 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7629 readonly data section is used.
7630
7631 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7632 @end defmac
7633
7634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7635 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7636 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7637 of its own that you need to create.
7638
7639 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7640 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7641 described below.
7642 @end deftypefn
7643
7644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7645 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7646 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7647 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7648 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7649
7650 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7651 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7652 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7653 in read-only sections even in executables.
7654 @end deftypefn
7655
7656 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_GENERATE_PIC_ADDR_DIFF_VEC (void)
7657 Return true to generate ADDR_DIF_VEC table
7658 or false to generate ADDR_VEC table for jumps in case of -fPIC.
7659
7660 The default version of this function returns true if flag_pic
7661 equals true and false otherwise
7662 @end deftypefn
7663
7664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7665 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7666 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7667 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7668 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7669 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7670 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7671
7672 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7673 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7674
7675 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7676 @end deftypefn
7677
7678 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7679 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7680 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7681
7682 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7683 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7684 it is unlikely to be called.
7685 @end defmac
7686
7687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7688 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7689 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7690 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7691 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7692
7693 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7694 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7695 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7696 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7697 @end deftypefn
7698
7699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7700 Return the readonly data section associated with
7701 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7702 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7703 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7704 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7705 otherwise.
7706 @end deftypefn
7707
7708 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7709 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7710 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7711 the string if a different section name should be used.
7712 @end deftypevr
7713
7714 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7715 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7716 @end deftypefn
7717
7718 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7719 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7720 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7721 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7722 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7723 in bits.
7724
7725 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7726 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7727 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7728 @end deftypefn
7729
7730 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7731 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7732 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7733 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7734 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7735 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7736 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7737 returns the @var{id} provided.
7738 @end deftypefn
7739
7740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7741 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7742 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7743 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7744
7745 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7746 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7747 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7748 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7749 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7750
7751 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7752 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7753 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7754 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7755 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7756 leave it alone.)
7757
7758 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7759 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7760 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7761 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7762 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7763 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7764
7765 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7766 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7767 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7768 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7769 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7770 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7771
7772 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7773 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7774 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7775 before overriding it.
7776 @end deftypefn
7777
7778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7779 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7780 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7781 may have added.
7782 @end deftypefn
7783
7784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7785 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7786 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7787 @end deftypefn
7788
7789 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7790 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7791 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7792 @end deftypevr
7793
7794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7795 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7796
7797 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7798 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7799 @end deftypefn
7800
7801 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7802 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7803 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7804 or executable image).
7805
7806 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7807 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7808 currently supported object file formats.
7809 @end deftypefn
7810
7811 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7812 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7813 The default value is false.
7814 @end deftypevr
7815
7816
7817 @node PIC
7818 @section Position Independent Code
7819 @cindex position independent code
7820 @cindex PIC
7821
7822 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7823 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7824 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7825 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7826 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7827 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7828 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7829 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7830 relative addresses.
7831 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7832 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7833
7834 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7835 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7836 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7837 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7838 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7839 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7840 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7841 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7842 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7843 @end defmac
7844
7845 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7846 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7847 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7848 the default is zero. Do not define
7849 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7850 @end defmac
7851
7852 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7853 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7854 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7855 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7856 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7857 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7858 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7859 position independent code.
7860 @end defmac
7861
7862 @node Assembler Format
7863 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7864
7865 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7866 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7867 instructions do.
7868
7869 @menu
7870 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7871 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7872 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7873 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7874 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7875 and termination routines.
7876 * Macros for Initialization::
7877 Specific macros that control the handling of
7878 initialization and termination routines.
7879 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7880 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7881 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7882 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7883 @end menu
7884
7885 @node File Framework
7886 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7887 @cindex assembler format
7888 @cindex output of assembler code
7889
7890 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7891 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7892
7893 @findex default_file_start
7894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7895 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7896 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7897 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7898 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7899 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7900 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7901 @end deftypefn
7902
7903 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7904 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7905 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7906 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7907 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7908 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7909 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7910 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7911
7912 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7913 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7914 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7915 @end deftypevr
7916
7917 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7918 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7919 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7920 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7921 this to be done. The default is false.
7922 @end deftypevr
7923
7924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7925 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7926 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7927 @end deftypefn
7928
7929 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7930 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7931 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7932 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7933 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7934 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7935 this function.
7936 @end deftypefun
7937
7938 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7939 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7940 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7941 nothing.
7942 @end deftypefn
7943
7944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7945 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7946 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7947 nothing.
7948 @end deftypefn
7949
7950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7951 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7952 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7953 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7954 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7955 nothing.
7956 @end deftypefn
7957
7958 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7959 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7960 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7961 the end of the line.
7962 @end defmac
7963
7964 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7965 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7966 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7967 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7968 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7969 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7970 @end defmac
7971
7972 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7973 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7974 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7975 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7976 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7977 @end defmac
7978
7979 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7980 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7981 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7982 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7983
7984 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7985 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7986 @end defmac
7987
7988 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7989 Output DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7990
7991 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7992 @end deftypefn
7993
7994 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7995 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7996 @end deftypefn
7997
7998 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7999 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
8000 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
8001 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
8002 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
8003 of the filename using this macro.
8004 @end defmac
8005
8006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
8007 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
8008 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
8009 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
8010 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
8011 this section is associated.
8012 @end deftypefn
8013
8014 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
8015 This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
8016 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
8017 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
8018 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
8019 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
8020 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
8021 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
8022 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
8023 is emitted.
8024 @end deftypefn
8025
8026 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
8027 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
8028 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
8029 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
8030 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
8031 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
8032 (from static destructors).
8033 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
8034 @end deftypefn
8035
8036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
8037 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
8038 @end deftypefn
8039
8040 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
8041 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
8042 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
8043 @end deftypevr
8044
8045 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
8046 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
8047 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
8048 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
8049 This is true on most ELF targets.
8050 @end deftypevr
8051
8052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
8053 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
8054 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
8055 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
8056 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
8057
8058 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
8059 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
8060 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
8061 set via @code{__attribute__}.
8062 @end deftypefn
8063
8064 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
8065 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
8066 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
8067 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
8068 It can take the following values:
8069
8070 @table @gcctabopt
8071 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
8072 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
8073
8074 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
8075 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
8076 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
8077 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
8078 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
8079 various different individual optimization passes.
8080
8081 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
8082 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
8083 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
8084 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
8085 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
8086 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
8087 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
8088 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
8089 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
8090 switches.
8091
8092 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
8093 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
8094
8095 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
8096 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
8097 @end table
8098
8099 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
8100 supported in the future.
8101
8102 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
8103 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
8104 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
8105 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
8106 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
8107 hook.
8108 @end deftypefn
8109
8110 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
8111 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
8112 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
8113 hook.
8114 @end deftypevr
8115
8116 @need 2000
8117 @node Data Output
8118 @subsection Output of Data
8119
8120
8121 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
8122 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
8123 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PSI_OP
8124 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
8125 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PDI_OP
8126 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
8127 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PTI_OP
8128 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
8129 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
8130 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PSI_OP
8131 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
8132 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PDI_OP
8133 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
8134 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PTI_OP
8135 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
8136 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
8137 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
8138 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
8139 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
8140 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
8141
8142 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
8143 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
8144 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
8145 @end deftypevr
8146
8147 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
8148 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
8149 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
8150 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
8151 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
8152 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
8153 split the object into smaller parts.
8154
8155 The default implementation of this hook will use the
8156 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
8157 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
8158 @end deftypefn
8159
8160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
8161 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
8162 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
8163 @end deftypefn
8164
8165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
8166 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
8167 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
8168 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
8169 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
8170
8171 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
8172 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
8173 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
8174 return @code{true}.
8175 @end deftypefn
8176
8177 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
8178 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8179 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
8180 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
8181 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
8182
8183 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
8184 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
8185 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
8186 @end defmac
8187
8188 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
8189 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
8190 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
8191 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
8192 @end defmac
8193
8194 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
8195 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
8196 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
8197 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
8198 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
8199 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
8200 pool before the function.
8201 @end defmac
8202
8203 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
8204 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
8205 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
8206 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
8207 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
8208 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
8209 immediately after this call.
8210
8211 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
8212 not be defined.
8213 @end defmac
8214
8215 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
8216 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
8217 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
8218 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
8219
8220 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
8221 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
8222 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
8223 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
8224 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
8225 alignment.
8226
8227 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
8228 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
8229 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
8230 Here is how to do this:
8231
8232 @smallexample
8233 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
8234 @end smallexample
8235
8236 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
8237 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
8238 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
8239
8240 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
8241 @end defmac
8242
8243 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
8244 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
8245 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
8246 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
8247 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
8248 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
8249
8250 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
8251 define this macro.
8252 @end defmac
8253
8254 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
8255 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
8256 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
8257 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
8258 a line separator uses multiple characters.
8259
8260 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
8261 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
8262 @end defmac
8263
8264 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
8265 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
8266 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
8267 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
8268 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8269 @end deftypevr
8270
8271 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
8272 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
8273
8274 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8275 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8276 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8277 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8278 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8279 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8280 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
8281 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
8282 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
8283 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
8284 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
8285 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
8286 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
8287 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
8288 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
8289 on the host machine.
8290
8291 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
8292 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
8293 machine's memory.
8294 @end defmac
8295
8296 @node Uninitialized Data
8297 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
8298
8299 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
8300 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
8301
8302 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8303 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8304 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
8305 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8306 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
8307 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
8308 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
8309 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
8310 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
8311 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
8312 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
8313 an ordinary undefined external.
8314
8315 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8316 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8317 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8318
8319 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8320 common global variables are output.
8321 @end defmac
8322
8323 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8324 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
8325 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8326 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
8327 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8328 as the number of bits.
8329 @end defmac
8330
8331 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8332 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
8333 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8334 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8335 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
8336 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
8337 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8338 @end defmac
8339
8340 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8341 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8342 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
8343 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
8344 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
8345
8346 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
8347 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
8348 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
8349 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
8350 the name, and a newline.
8351
8352 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
8353 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8354 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8355 You do not need to do both.
8356
8357 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8358 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8359 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
8360 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8361 common in order to save space in the object file.
8362 @end defmac
8363
8364 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8365 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8366 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8367 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8368 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8369
8370 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8371 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8372 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8373
8374 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8375 static variables are output.
8376 @end defmac
8377
8378 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8379 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8380 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8381 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8382 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8383 as the number of bits.
8384 @end defmac
8385
8386 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8387 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL} except that @var{decl} of the
8388 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8389 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8390 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} and
8391 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8392 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8393 @end defmac
8394
8395 @node Label Output
8396 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8397
8398 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8399 This is about outputting labels.
8400
8401 @findex assemble_name
8402 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8403 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8404 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8405 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8406 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8407 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8408 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8409 @end defmac
8410
8411 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8412 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8413 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8414 a function.
8415 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8416 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8417 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8418 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8419
8420 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8421 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8422 @end defmac
8423
8424 @findex assemble_name_raw
8425 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8426 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8427 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8428 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8429 that it is more efficient.
8430 @end defmac
8431
8432 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8433 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8434 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8435 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8436 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8437
8438 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8439 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8440 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8441 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8442 define this macro.
8443 @end defmac
8444
8445 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8446 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8447 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8448 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8449 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8450 provided.
8451 @end defmac
8452
8453 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8454 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8455 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8456 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8457 address.
8458
8459 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8460 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8461 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8462 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8463 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8464 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8465 @end defmac
8466
8467 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8468 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8469 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8470 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8471 @samp{.} is used instead.
8472 @end defmac
8473
8474 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8475 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8476 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8477 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8478 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8479 @end defmac
8480
8481 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8482 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8483 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8484 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8485 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8486
8487 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8488 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8489 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8490 types at all, do not define this macro.
8491 @end defmac
8492
8493 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8494 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8495 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8496 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8497 the default is not to define this macro.
8498
8499 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8500 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8501 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8502 types at all, do not define this macro.
8503 @end defmac
8504
8505 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8506 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8507 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8508 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8509 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8510 you should not count on this.
8511
8512 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8513 definition of this macro is provided.
8514 @end defmac
8515
8516 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8517 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8518 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8519 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8520 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8521 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8522 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8523
8524 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8525 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8526
8527 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8528 of this macro.
8529 @end defmac
8530
8531 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8532 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8533 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8534 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8535 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8536 representing the function.
8537
8538 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8539
8540 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8541 of this macro.
8542 @end defmac
8543
8544 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8545 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8546 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8547 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8548 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8549 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8550 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8551
8552 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8553 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8554
8555 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8556 of this macro.
8557 @end defmac
8558
8559 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8560 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8561 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8562 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8563 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8564 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8565
8566 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8567
8568 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8569 of this macro.
8570 @end defmac
8571
8572 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8573 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8574 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8575 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8576 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8577 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8578
8579 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8580 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8581
8582 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8583 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8584 @end defmac
8585
8586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8587 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8588 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8589 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8590 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8591 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8592 will be an internal label.
8593
8594 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8595 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8596
8597 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8598 @end deftypefn
8599
8600 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8601 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8602 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8603 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8604
8605 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8606 nothing.
8607 @end defmac
8608
8609 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8610 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8611 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8612 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8613 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8614 something about the size of the object.
8615
8616 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8617 nothing.
8618
8619 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8620 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8621 @end defmac
8622
8623 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8624 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8625 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8626 that is, available for reference from other files.
8627
8628 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8629 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8630 @end deftypefn
8631
8632 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8633 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8634 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8635 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8636
8637 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8638 @end deftypefn
8639
8640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8641 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8642 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8643 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8644 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8645 @end deftypefn
8646
8647 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8648 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8649 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8650 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8651 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8652 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8653 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8654 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8655
8656 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8657 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8658 macro.
8659 @end defmac
8660
8661 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8662 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8663 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8664 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8665 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8666 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8667 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8668 to make @var{name} weak.
8669 @end defmac
8670
8671 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8672 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8673 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8674 declaration of @code{name}.
8675 @end defmac
8676
8677 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8678 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8679 supports weak symbols.
8680
8681 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8682 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8683 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8684 @end defmac
8685
8686 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8687 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8688
8689 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8690 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8691 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8692 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8693 @end defmac
8694
8695 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8696 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8697 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8698 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8699 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8700 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8701 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8702 @end defmac
8703
8704 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8705 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8706 semantics.
8707
8708 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8709 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8710 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8711 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8712 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8713 be emitted as one-only.
8714 @end defmac
8715
8716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8717 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8718 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8719 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8720 @end deftypefn
8721
8722 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8723 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8724 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8725 The default is @code{0}.
8726
8727 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8728 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8729 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8730 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8731 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8732 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8733 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8734
8735 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8736 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8737 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8738 table of contents.
8739 @end defmac
8740
8741 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8742 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8743 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8744 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8745 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8746 declaration.
8747
8748 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8749 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8750 @end defmac
8751
8752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8753 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8754 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8755 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8756 @end deftypefn
8757
8758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8759 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8760 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8761 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8762 @end deftypefn
8763
8764 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8765 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8766 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8767 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8768 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8769 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8770 @end defmac
8771
8772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8773 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8774 @end deftypefn
8775
8776 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8777 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8778 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8779 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8780 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8781 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8782 @end defmac
8783
8784 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8785 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8786 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8787 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8788 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8789 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8790 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8791 being taken.
8792 @end defmac
8793
8794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8795 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8796 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8797
8798 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8799 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8800 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8801
8802 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8803 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8804 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8805 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8806 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8807
8808 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8809 @end deftypefn
8810
8811 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8812 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8813 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8814 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8815 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8816 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8817 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8818 bundles.
8819
8820 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8821 used.
8822 @end defmac
8823
8824 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8825 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8826 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8827
8828 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8829 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8830 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8831
8832 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8833 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8834 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8835 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8836 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8837 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8838 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8839 @end defmac
8840
8841 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8842 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8843 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8844 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8845 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8846
8847 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8848 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8849 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8850 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8851 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8852 internal static variables in different scopes.
8853
8854 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8855 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8856 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8857 between the name and the number will suffice.
8858
8859 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8860 which is correct for most systems.
8861 @end defmac
8862
8863 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8864 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8865 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8866
8867 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8868 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8869 correct for most systems.
8870 @end defmac
8871
8872 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8873 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8874 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8875 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8876 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8877 the tree nodes are available.
8878
8879 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8880 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8881 correct for most systems.
8882 @end defmac
8883
8884 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8885 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8886 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8887 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8888 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8889 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8890 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8891 @end defmac
8892
8893 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8894 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8895 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8896 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8897 an undefined weak symbol.
8898
8899 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8900 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8901 @end defmac
8902
8903 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8904 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8905 Objective-C methods.
8906
8907 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8908 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8909 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8910 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8911
8912 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8913 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8914 systems define other ways of computing names.
8915
8916 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8917 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8918 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8919 50 characters extra.
8920
8921 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8922 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8923 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8924 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8925
8926 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8927 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8928 @end defmac
8929
8930 @node Initialization
8931 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8932 @cindex initialization routines
8933 @cindex termination routines
8934 @cindex constructors, output of
8935 @cindex destructors, output of
8936
8937 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8938 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8939 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8940 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8941 @code{main} is called.
8942
8943 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8944 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8945 terminates.
8946
8947 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8948 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8949 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8950 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8951
8952 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8953 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8954 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8955
8956 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8957 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8958 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8959 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8960 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8961
8962 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8963 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8964 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8965 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8966 pointer containing zero.
8967
8968 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8969 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8970 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8971 list; destructors in forward order.
8972
8973 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8974 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8975 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8976 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8977 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8978 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8979 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8980 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8981
8982 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8983 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8984 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8985 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8986 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8987
8988 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8989 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8990 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8991 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8992 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8993
8994 @smallexample
8995 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8996 @end smallexample
8997
8998 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8999 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
9000 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
9001 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
9002 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
9003
9004 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
9005 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
9006 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
9007 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
9008 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
9009 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
9010
9011 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
9012 macro properly.
9013
9014 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
9015 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
9016 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
9017 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
9018 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
9019 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
9020
9021 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
9022 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
9023 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
9024 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
9025 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
9026 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
9027 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
9028 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
9029 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
9030 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
9031 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
9032 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
9033 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
9034 the initialization process.
9035
9036 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
9037 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
9038 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
9039 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
9040 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
9041 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
9042 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
9043 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
9044 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
9045 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
9046 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
9047
9048 @ifinfo
9049 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
9050 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
9051 @end ifinfo
9052
9053 @node Macros for Initialization
9054 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
9055
9056 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
9057 and termination functions:
9058
9059 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
9060 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
9061 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
9062 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
9063 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
9064 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
9065 run the initialization functions.
9066 @end defmac
9067
9068 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
9069 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
9070 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
9071 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
9072 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
9073 @end defmac
9074
9075 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
9076 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
9077 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
9078 @end defmac
9079
9080 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
9081 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
9082 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
9083 @end defmac
9084
9085 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
9086 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
9087 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
9088 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
9089 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
9090 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
9091
9092 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
9093 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
9094 exception tables embedded in the code.
9095 @end defmac
9096
9097 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
9098 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
9099 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
9100 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
9101 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
9102 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
9103 @end defmac
9104
9105 @defmac INVOKE__main
9106 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
9107 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
9108 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
9109 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
9110 @end defmac
9111
9112 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
9113 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
9114 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
9115 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
9116 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
9117 @end defmac
9118
9119 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
9120 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
9121 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
9122 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
9123 @end deftypevr
9124
9125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
9126 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
9127 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
9128
9129 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
9130 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
9131 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
9132 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
9133
9134 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
9135 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
9136 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
9137 is not defined.
9138 @end deftypefn
9139
9140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
9141 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
9142 functions rather than initialization functions.
9143 @end deftypefn
9144
9145 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
9146 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
9147
9148 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
9149 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
9150 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
9151
9152 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
9153 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
9154
9155 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
9156 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
9157 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
9158 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
9159
9160 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
9161 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
9162 @end defmac
9163
9164 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
9165 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
9166 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
9167 @command{nm}.
9168 @end defmac
9169
9170 @defmac NM_FLAGS
9171 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
9172 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
9173 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
9174 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
9175 produces.
9176 @end defmac
9177
9178 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
9179 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
9180 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
9181 termination functions in shared libraries:
9182
9183 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
9184 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
9185 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
9186 @end defmac
9187
9188 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
9189 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
9190 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
9191 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
9192 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
9193 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
9194 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
9195 @end defmac
9196
9197 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
9198 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
9199 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
9200 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
9201 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
9202 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
9203 @end defmac
9204
9205 @node Instruction Output
9206 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
9207
9208 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9209 This describes assembler instruction output.
9210
9211 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
9212 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
9213 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
9214 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
9215 @end defmac
9216
9217 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9218 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
9219 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
9220 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
9221 to registers using alternate names.
9222 @end defmac
9223
9224 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
9225 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
9226 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
9227 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
9228 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
9229 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
9230 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
9231 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
9232
9233 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
9234 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
9235 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
9236 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
9237 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
9238 @end defmac
9239
9240 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
9241 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
9242 requires different names for the machine instructions.
9243
9244 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
9245 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
9246 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
9247 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
9248 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
9249 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
9250 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
9251 so that it will not be output twice.
9252
9253 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
9254 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
9255 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
9256 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
9257 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
9258
9259 @findex recog_data.operand
9260 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
9261 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
9262
9263 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
9264 in the usual way.
9265 @end defmac
9266
9267 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
9268 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
9269 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
9270 they will be output differently.
9271
9272 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9273 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9274 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9275 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
9276 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
9277 by changing the contents of the vector.
9278
9279 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
9280 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
9281 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
9282 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
9283 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
9284 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
9285
9286 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
9287 @end defmac
9288
9289 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
9290 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
9291 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
9292 if necessary.
9293
9294 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9295 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9296 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9297 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
9298 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
9299 by checking the contents of the vector.
9300 @end deftypefn
9301
9302 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
9303 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9304 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
9305 RTL expression.
9306
9307 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
9308 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
9309 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
9310 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
9311 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
9312 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
9313 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
9314
9315 @findex reg_names
9316 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
9317 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
9318 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
9319 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
9320
9321 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
9322 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
9323 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
9324 @var{code}.
9325 @end defmac
9326
9327 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
9328 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
9329 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
9330 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
9331 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
9332 in this way.
9333 @end defmac
9334
9335 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
9336 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9337 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
9338 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
9339
9340 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
9341 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
9342 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
9343 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
9344 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
9345 Format}.
9346 @end defmac
9347
9348 @findex dbr_sequence_length
9349 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
9350 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
9351 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
9352 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9353 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9354 or whatever.
9355
9356 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9357 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
9358 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
9359 @end defmac
9360
9361 @findex final_sequence
9362 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
9363 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9364 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
9365 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9366 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9367 being output.
9368
9369 @findex asm_fprintf
9370 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9371 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9372 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9373 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9374 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9375 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9376 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9377 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9378 files can define these macros differently.
9379 @end defmac
9380
9381 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9382 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9383 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9384 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9385 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9386 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9387 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9388 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9389 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9390 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9391 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9392 @end defmac
9393
9394 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9395 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9396 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9397 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9398 first variant.
9399
9400 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9401 @smallexample
9402 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9403 @end smallexample
9404 @noindent
9405 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9406 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9407 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9408 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9409 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9410 alternatives within the braces than the value of
9411 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9412 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9413 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9414
9415 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9416 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9417 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9418
9419 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9420 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9421 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
9422 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9423 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9424 opcodes or operand order.
9425 @end defmac
9426
9427 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9428 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9429 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9430 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9431 profiling.
9432 @end defmac
9433
9434 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9435 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9436 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9437 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9438 profiling.
9439 @end defmac
9440
9441 @node Dispatch Tables
9442 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9443
9444 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9445 This concerns dispatch tables.
9446
9447 @cindex dispatch table
9448 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9449 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9450 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9451 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9452 definitions of these labels are output using
9453 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9454 way here. For example,
9455
9456 @smallexample
9457 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9458 @var{value}, @var{rel})
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9462 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
9463 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9464 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9465 mode and flags can be read.
9466 @end defmac
9467
9468 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9469 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9470 in a dispatch table are absolute.
9471
9472 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9473 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9474 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9475 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9476 For example,
9477
9478 @smallexample
9479 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9480 @end smallexample
9481 @end defmac
9482
9483 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9484 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9485 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9486 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9487 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9488 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9489
9490 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9491 for the table.
9492
9493 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9494 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9495 @end defmac
9496
9497 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9498 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9499 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9500 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9501 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9502 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9503 of the preceding label.
9504
9505 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9506 the jump-table.
9507 @end defmac
9508
9509 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_POST_CFI_STARTPROC (FILE *@var{}, @var{tree})
9510 This target hook is used to emit assembly strings required by the target
9511 after the .cfi_startproc directive. The first argument is the file stream to
9512 write the strings to and the second argument is the function's declaration. The
9513 expected use is to add more .cfi_* directives.
9514
9515 The default is to not output any assembly strings.
9516 @end deftypefn
9517
9518 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9519 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9520 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9521 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9522 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9523 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9524 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9525 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9526
9527 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9528 @end deftypefn
9529
9530 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9531 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9532 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9533 to be broken up according to function.
9534
9535 The default is that no label is emitted.
9536 @end deftypefn
9537
9538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9539 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9540 @end deftypefn
9541
9542 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9543 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9544 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9545 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9546 @end deftypefn
9547
9548 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9549 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9550 @end deftypevr
9551
9552 @node Exception Region Output
9553 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9554
9555 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9556
9557 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9558 region.
9559
9560 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9561 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9562 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9563 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9564 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9565
9566 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9567 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9568 @end defmac
9569
9570 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9571 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9572 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9573 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9574
9575 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9576 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9577 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9578 be marked as not to be collected.
9579 @end defmac
9580
9581 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9582 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9583 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9584 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9585 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9586 @end defmac
9587
9588 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9589 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9590 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9591 @end defmac
9592
9593 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9594 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9595 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9596 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9597 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9598 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9599 @end defmac
9600
9601 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9602 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9603 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9604 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9605 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9606 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9607 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9608
9609 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9610 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9611 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9612
9613 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9614 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9615 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9616 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9617 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9618 depending on this setting.
9619
9620 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9621 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9622 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9623 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9624 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9625 @end deftypefn
9626
9627 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9628 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9629 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9630 command-line option processing.
9631 @end deftypevr
9632
9633 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9634 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9635 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9636 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9637 @end defmac
9638
9639 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9640 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9641 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9642 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9643 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9644 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9645 @end defmac
9646
9647 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9648 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9649 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9650 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9651 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9652 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{DWARF}. Only applicable if
9653 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9654 @end defmac
9655
9656 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9657 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9658 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9659 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9660 true otherwise.
9661 @end deftypevr
9662
9663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9664 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9665 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9666 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9667 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9668 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9669 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9670 @end deftypefn
9671
9672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9673 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9674 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9675 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9676 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9677 @end deftypefn
9678
9679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9680 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9681 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9682 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9683 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9684 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9685 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9686 @end deftypefn
9687
9688 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9689 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9690 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9691 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9692 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9693 @end deftypefn
9694
9695 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9696 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9697 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9698 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9699 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9700 @end deftypevr
9701
9702 @node Alignment Output
9703 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9704
9705 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9706 This describes commands for alignment.
9707
9708 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9709 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9710 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9711
9712 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9713 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9714 define the macro.
9715
9716 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9717 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9718 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9719 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9720 @end defmac
9721
9722 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9723 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9724 a @code{BARRIER}.
9725
9726 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9727 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9728 define the macro.
9729 @end defmac
9730
9731 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9732 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9733 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9734
9735 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9736 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9737 define the macro.
9738
9739 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9740 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9741 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9742 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9743 @end defmac
9744
9745 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9746 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9747 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9748 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9749
9750 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9751 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9752 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9753 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9754 @end defmac
9755
9756 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9757 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9758 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9759 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9760 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9761 @end defmac
9762
9763 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9764 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9765 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9766 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9767 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9768 section.
9769 @end defmac
9770
9771 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9772 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9773 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9774 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9775 @end defmac
9776
9777 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9778 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9779 for padding, if necessary.
9780 @end defmac
9781
9782 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9783 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9784 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9785 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9786 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9787 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9788 @end defmac
9789
9790 @need 3000
9791 @node Debugging Info
9792 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9793
9794 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9795 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9796
9797 @menu
9798 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9799 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9800 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9801 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9802 * DWARF:: Macros for DWARF format.
9803 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9804 @end menu
9805
9806 @node All Debuggers
9807 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9808
9809 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9810 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9811
9812 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9813 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9814 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9815 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9816 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9817 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9818 compiler and another for DBX@.
9819
9820 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9821 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9822 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9823 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9824 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9825
9826 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9827 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9828 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9829 @end defmac
9830
9831 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9832 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9833 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9834 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9835 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9836 that produce debugging output for DBX and allow the frame-pointer to be
9837 eliminated when the @option{-g} option is used.
9838 @end defmac
9839
9840 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9841 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9842 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9843 @var{offset}.
9844 @end defmac
9845
9846 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9847 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9848 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9849 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9850 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9851 @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG},
9852 and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9853
9854 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9855 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9856 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9857 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9858 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9859
9860 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9861 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9862 @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9863 @end defmac
9864
9865 @node DBX Options
9866 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9867
9868 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9869 These are specific options for DBX output.
9870
9871 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9872 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9873 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9874 @end defmac
9875
9876 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9877 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9878 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9879 @end defmac
9880
9881 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9882 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9883 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9884 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9885 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9886 if there is any occasion to.
9887 @end defmac
9888
9889 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9890 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9891 in the text section.
9892 @end defmac
9893
9894 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9895 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9896 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9897 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9898 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9899 @end defmac
9900
9901 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9902 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9903 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9904 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9905 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9906 information format.
9907 @end defmac
9908
9909 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9910 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9911 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9912 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9913 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9914 @end defmac
9915
9916 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9917 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9918 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9919 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9920 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9921 @end defmac
9922
9923 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9924 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9925 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9926 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9927 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9928 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9929 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9930 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9931 @end defmac
9932
9933 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9934 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9935 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9936 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9937 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9938 if backslash is correct for your system.
9939 @end defmac
9940
9941 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9942 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9943 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9944 variable.
9945 @end defmac
9946
9947 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9948 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9949 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9950 @end defmac
9951
9952 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9953 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9954 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9955 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9956 @end defmac
9957
9958 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9959 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9960 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9961 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9962 @end defmac
9963
9964 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9965 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9966 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9967 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9968 @end defmac
9969
9970 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9971 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9972 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9973 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9974 code.
9975 @end defmac
9976
9977 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9978 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9979 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9980 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9981 an absolute address.
9982 @end defmac
9983
9984 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9985 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9986 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9987 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9988 @end defmac
9989
9990 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9991 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9992 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9993 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9994 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9995 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9996 number for a type number.
9997 @end defmac
9998
9999 @node DBX Hooks
10000 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
10001
10002 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10003 These are hooks for DBX format.
10004
10005 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
10006 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
10007 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
10008 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
10009 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
10010 unique labels in the assembly output.
10011
10012 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
10013 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
10014 @end defmac
10015
10016 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
10017 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
10018 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
10019 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
10020 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
10021 @end defmac
10022
10023 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
10024 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
10025 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
10026 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
10027 @end defmac
10028
10029 @node File Names and DBX
10030 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
10031
10032 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10033 This describes file names in DBX format.
10034
10035 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
10036 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
10037 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
10038 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
10039 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
10040
10041 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
10042 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
10043
10044 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
10045 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
10046 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
10047 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
10048 @end defmac
10049
10050 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
10051 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
10052 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
10053 the beginning of the file.
10054 @end defmac
10055
10056 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
10057 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
10058 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
10059 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
10060 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
10061 @end defmac
10062
10063 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
10064 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
10065 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
10066 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
10067
10068 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
10069 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
10070 @end defmac
10071
10072 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
10073 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
10074 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
10075 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
10076 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
10077 @end defmac
10078
10079 @need 2000
10080 @node DWARF
10081 @subsection Macros for DWARF Output
10082
10083 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10084 Here are macros for DWARF output.
10085
10086 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
10087 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
10088 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
10089
10090 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
10091 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
10092 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
10093 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
10094 @end deftypefn
10095
10096 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
10097 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
10098 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
10099 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
10100 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
10101 @end defmac
10102
10103 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
10104 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
10105 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
10106 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
10107 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
10108 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
10109 @end defmac
10110
10111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
10112 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
10113 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
10114 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
10115 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
10116
10117 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
10118 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
10119
10120 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
10121 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
10122 @end deftypefn
10123
10124 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
10125 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
10126 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
10127 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
10128 @end defmac
10129
10130 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
10131 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler supports view
10132 assignment and verification in @code{.loc}. If it does not, but the
10133 user enables location views, the compiler may have to fallback to
10134 internal line number tables.
10135 @end defmac
10136
10137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RESET_LOCATION_VIEW (rtx_insn *@var{})
10138 This hook, if defined, enables -ginternal-reset-location-views, and
10139 uses its result to override cases in which the estimated min insn
10140 length might be nonzero even when a PC advance (i.e., a view reset)
10141 cannot be taken for granted.
10142
10143 If the hook is defined, it must return a positive value to indicate
10144 the insn definitely advances the PC, and so the view number can be
10145 safely assumed to be reset; a negative value to mean the insn
10146 definitely does not advance the PC, and os the view number must not
10147 be reset; or zero to decide based on the estimated insn length.
10148
10149 If insn length is to be regarded as reliable, set the hook to
10150 @code{hook_int_rtx_insn_0}.
10151 @end deftypefn
10152
10153 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
10154 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
10155 @end deftypevr
10156
10157 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
10158 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
10159 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10160 @end deftypevr
10161
10162 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
10163 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
10164 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10165 @end deftypevr
10166
10167 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
10168 True if register allocation and the passes
10169 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
10170 targets.
10171 @end deftypevr
10172
10173 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10174 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10175 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10176 @end defmac
10177
10178 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10179 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10180 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g.@: instruction
10181 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
10182 @end defmac
10183
10184 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
10185 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
10186 section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
10187 an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
10188 given @var{section}.
10189 @end defmac
10190
10191 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10192 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
10193 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10194 @end defmac
10195
10196 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10197 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
10198 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10199 @end defmac
10200
10201 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
10202 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
10203 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
10204 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
10205 is referenced by a function.
10206 @end defmac
10207
10208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
10209 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
10210 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
10211 @end deftypefn
10212
10213 @need 2000
10214 @node VMS Debug
10215 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
10216
10217 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10218 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
10219
10220 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10221 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
10222 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
10223 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
10224 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
10225 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
10226 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
10227 @end defmac
10228
10229 @node Floating Point
10230 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
10231 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
10232 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
10233
10234 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
10235 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
10236 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
10237 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
10238 doing the compilation.
10239
10240 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
10241 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
10242 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
10243 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
10244 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
10245 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
10246 target floating point formats are identical.
10247
10248 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
10249 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
10250 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
10251 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
10252
10253 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
10254 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
10255 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
10256 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
10257 quantity.
10258 @end defmac
10259
10260 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10261 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
10262 @end deftypefn
10263
10264 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10265 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
10266 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
10267 @end deftypefn
10268
10269 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
10270 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
10271 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
10272 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
10273 defined by the C language for both.
10274 @end deftypefn
10275
10276 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10277 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
10278 @end deftypefn
10279
10280 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10281 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
10282 @end deftypefn
10283
10284 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10285 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
10286 @end deftypefn
10287
10288 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10289 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
10290 @end deftypefn
10291
10292 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10293 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
10294 @end deftypefn
10295
10296 @node Mode Switching
10297 @section Mode Switching Instructions
10298 @cindex mode switching
10299 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
10300
10301 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
10302 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
10303 switching in an optimizing compilation.
10304
10305 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
10306 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
10307 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
10308 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
10309 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
10310 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting
10311 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
10312
10313 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
10314 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
10315 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
10316 If you define this macro, you also have to define
10317 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
10318 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
10319 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
10320 are optional.
10321 @end defmac
10322
10323 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
10324 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10325 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
10326 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10327 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
10328 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10329 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
10330 entity in question.
10331 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
10332 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
10333 switch is needed / supplied.
10334 @end defmac
10335
10336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10337 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10338 @end deftypefn
10339
10340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10341 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10342 @end deftypefn
10343
10344 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10345 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10346 @end deftypefn
10347
10348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10349 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10350 @end deftypefn
10351
10352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10353 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10354 @end deftypefn
10355
10356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10357 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10358 @end deftypefn
10359
10360 @node Target Attributes
10361 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10362 @cindex target attributes
10363 @cindex machine attributes
10364 @cindex attributes, target-specific
10365
10366 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10367 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10368 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10369
10370 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10371 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10372 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10373 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10374 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10375 take.
10376 @end deftypevr
10377
10378 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10379 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10380 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10381 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10382 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10383 false for all machine-specific attributes.
10384 @end deftypefn
10385
10386 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10387 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10388 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10389 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10390 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10391 supposed always to be compatible.
10392 @end deftypefn
10393
10394 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10395 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10396 the newly defined @var{type}.
10397 @end deftypefn
10398
10399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10400 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10401 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10402 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10403 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10404 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10405 merging.
10406 @end deftypefn
10407
10408 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10409 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10410 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10411 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10412 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10413 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10414 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10415 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10416
10417 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10418 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10419 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10420 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10421 will then define a function called
10422 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10423 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10424 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10425 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10426 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10427 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10428 @end deftypefn
10429
10430 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10431 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10432 @end deftypefn
10433
10434 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10435 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10436 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10437 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10438 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10439 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10440 on this implementation detail.
10441 @end defmac
10442
10443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10444 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10445 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10446 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10447 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10448 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10449 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10450 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10451 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10452 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10453 needed.
10454 @end deftypefn
10455
10456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_HANDLE_GENERIC_ATTRIBUTE (tree *@var{node}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags}, bool *@var{no_add_attrs})
10457 Define this target hook if you want to be able to perform additional
10458 target-specific processing of an attribute which is handled generically
10459 by a front end. The arguments are the same as those which are passed to
10460 attribute handlers. So far this only affects the @var{noinit} and
10461 @var{section} attribute.
10462 @end deftypefn
10463
10464 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10465 @cindex inlining
10466 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10467 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10468 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10469 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10470 @end deftypefn
10471
10472 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10473 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10474 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10475 These function-specific options may differ
10476 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10477 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10478
10479 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10480 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10481 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10482 @end deftypefn
10483
10484 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10485 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10486 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10487 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10488 @xref{Option file format}.
10489 @end deftypefn
10490
10491 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10492 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10493 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10494 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10495 @end deftypefn
10496
10497 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10498 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10499 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10500 LTO bytecode.
10501 @end deftypefn
10502
10503 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10504 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10505 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10506 function-specific options.
10507 @end deftypefn
10508
10509 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10510 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10511 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10512 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10513 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10514 @end deftypefn
10515
10516 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10517 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10518 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10519 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10520 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10521
10522 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10523 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10524
10525 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10526 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10527 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10528 @end deftypefn
10529
10530 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10531 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10532 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10533 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10534 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10535 different target machines.
10536 @end deftypefn
10537
10538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10539 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10540 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10541 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10542 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10543 @end deftypefn
10544
10545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10546 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10547 @end deftypefn
10548
10549 @node Emulated TLS
10550 @section Emulating TLS
10551 @cindex Emulated TLS
10552
10553 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10554 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10555 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10556 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10557 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10558 layer.
10559
10560 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10561 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10562 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10563 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10564
10565 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10566 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10567 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10568 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10569 @end deftypevr
10570
10571 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10572 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10573 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10574 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10575 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10576 registration function to be used.
10577 @end deftypevr
10578
10579 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10580 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10581 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10582 any section.
10583 @end deftypevr
10584
10585 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10586 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10587 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10588 section.
10589 @end deftypevr
10590
10591 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10592 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10593 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10594 @end deftypevr
10595
10596 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10597 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10598 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10599 @end deftypevr
10600
10601 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10602 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10603 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10604 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10605 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10606 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10607 @end deftypefn
10608
10609 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10610 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10611 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10612 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10613 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10614 @end deftypefn
10615
10616 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10617 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10618 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10619 single objects. The default is false.
10620 @end deftypevr
10621
10622 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10623 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10624 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10625 @end deftypevr
10626
10627 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10628 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10629 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10630
10631 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10632 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10633 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10634 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10635
10636 @smallexample
10637 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10638 unsigned int d;
10639
10640 d = cp0count + 3;
10641 @end smallexample
10642
10643 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10644 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10645 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10646
10647 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10648 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10649 later in the function.
10650
10651 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10652 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10653 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10654
10655 @node PCH Target
10656 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10657 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10658
10659 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10660 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10661 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10662 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10663 @end deftypefn
10664
10665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10666 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10667 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10668 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10669 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10670
10671 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10672 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10673 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10674 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10675
10676 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10677 suitable for most targets.
10678 @end deftypefn
10679
10680 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10681 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10682 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10683 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10684 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10685 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10686 @end deftypefn
10687
10688 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10689 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10690 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10691 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10692 to do anything here.
10693 @end deftypefn
10694
10695 @node C++ ABI
10696 @section C++ ABI parameters
10697 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10698
10699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10700 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10701 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10702 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10703 @end deftypefn
10704
10705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10706 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10707 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10708 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10709 @end deftypefn
10710
10711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10712 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10713 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10714 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10715 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10716 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10717 @end deftypefn
10718
10719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10720 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10721 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10722 @end deftypefn
10723
10724 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10725 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10726 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10727 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10728 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10729 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10730 backend's targeted operating system.
10731 @end deftypefn
10732
10733 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10734 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10735 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10736 @code{false}.
10737 @end deftypefn
10738
10739 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10740 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10741 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10742 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10743 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10744 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10745 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10746 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10747 @end deftypefn
10748
10749 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10750 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10751 @end deftypefn
10752
10753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10754 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10755 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10756 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10757 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10758 unit will not be COMDAT.
10759 @end deftypefn
10760
10761 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10762 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10763 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10764 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10765 @end deftypefn
10766
10767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10768 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10769 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10770 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10771 @end deftypefn
10772
10773 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10774 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10775 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10776 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10777 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10778 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10779 @end deftypefn
10780
10781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10782 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10783 @end deftypefn
10784
10785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10786 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10787 @end deftypefn
10788
10789 @node D Language and ABI
10790 @section D ABI parameters
10791 @cindex parameters, d abi
10792
10793 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS (void)
10794 Declare all environmental version identifiers relating to the target CPU
10795 using the function @code{builtin_version}, which takes a string representing
10796 the name of the version. Version identifiers predefined by this hook apply
10797 to all modules that are being compiled and imported.
10798 @end deftypefn
10799
10800 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_OS_VERSIONS (void)
10801 Similarly to @code{TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS}, but is used for versions
10802 relating to the target operating system.
10803 @end deftypefn
10804
10805 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_D_CRITSEC_SIZE (void)
10806 Returns the size of the data structure used by the target operating system
10807 for critical sections and monitors. For example, on Microsoft Windows this
10808 would return the @code{sizeof(CRITICAL_SECTION)}, while other platforms that
10809 implement pthreads would return @code{sizeof(pthread_mutex_t)}.
10810 @end deftypefn
10811
10812 @node Named Address Spaces
10813 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10814 @cindex named address spaces
10815
10816 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10817 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10818 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10819 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10820 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10821 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10822 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10823 @code{const} type attributes.
10824
10825 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10826 pointers to the generic address space.
10827
10828 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10829 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10830 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10831 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10832 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10833 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10834 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10835 always 32 bits).
10836
10837 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10838 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10839 address space.
10840
10841 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10842 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10843 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10844 named address space #1:
10845 @smallexample
10846 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10847 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10848 @end smallexample
10849
10850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10851 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10852 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10853 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10854 @end deftypefn
10855
10856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10857 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10858 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10859 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10860 @end deftypefn
10861
10862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10863 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10864 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10865 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10866 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10867 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10868 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10869 target hooks for the given address space.
10870 @end deftypefn
10871
10872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10873 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10874 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10875 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10876 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10877 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10878 explicit named address space support.
10879 @end deftypefn
10880
10881 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10882 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10883 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10884 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10885 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10886 @end deftypefn
10887
10888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10889 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10890 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10891 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10892 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10893 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10894 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10895 @end deftypefn
10896
10897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10898 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10899 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10900 @end deftypefn
10901
10902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10903 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10904 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10905 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10906 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10907 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10908 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10909 @end deftypefn
10910
10911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10912 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10913 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10914 @end deftypefn
10915
10916 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10917 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10918 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10919 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10920 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10921 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10922 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10923 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10924 The default implementation does nothing.
10925 @end deftypefn
10926
10927 @node Misc
10928 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10929 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10930
10931 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10932 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10933
10934 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10935 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10936 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10937 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10938 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10939 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10940 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10941 @end defmac
10942
10943 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10944 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10945 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10946 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10947 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10948 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10949 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10950 @end defmac
10951
10952 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10953 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10954 elements of a jump-table should have.
10955 @end defmac
10956
10957 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10958 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10959 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10960 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10961 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10962 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10963 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10964 flags can be updated.
10965 @end defmac
10966
10967 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10968 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10969 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10970 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10971 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10972 is in effect.
10973 @end defmac
10974
10975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10976 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10977 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10978 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10979 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10980 @end deftypefn
10981
10982 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10983 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10984 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register. To be
10985 more explicit, if you start with a pair of @code{word_mode} registers with
10986 known values and you do a subword, for example @code{QImode}, addition on
10987 the low part of the registers, then the compiler may consider that the
10988 result has a known value in @code{word_mode} too if the macro is defined
10989 to 1. Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10990 @end defmac
10991
10992 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
10993 On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
10994 maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
10995 arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
10996
10997 On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
10998 using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
10999 of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
11000
11001 More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
11002 compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
11003 with a precision lower than the word precision.
11004
11005 You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
11006 defined to 1.
11007 @end deftypefn
11008
11009 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
11010 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
11011 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
11012 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
11013 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
11014 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
11015 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
11016 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
11017
11018 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
11019 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
11020 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
11021 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
11022 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
11023
11024 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
11025 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
11026 of these hard registers @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false
11027 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
11028 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
11029
11030 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
11031 mode, @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
11032 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
11033 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
11034 @end defmac
11035
11036 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
11037 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
11038 extends.
11039 @end defmac
11040
11041 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
11042 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
11043 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
11044 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
11045 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
11046 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
11047 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
11048 @end deftypefn
11049
11050 @defmac MOVE_MAX
11051 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
11052 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
11053 @end defmac
11054
11055 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
11056 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
11057 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
11058 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
11059 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
11060 at run-time.
11061 @end defmac
11062
11063 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
11064 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
11065 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
11066 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
11067 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
11068 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
11069 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
11070 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
11071 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
11072 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
11073 arguments to bit-field instructions.
11074
11075 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
11076 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
11077 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
11078
11079 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
11080 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
11081 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
11082 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
11083 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
11084
11085 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
11086 @end defmac
11087
11088 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
11089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
11090 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
11091 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
11092 @xref{shift patterns}.
11093
11094 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
11095 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
11096 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
11097 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
11098 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
11099 particular behavior is guaranteed.
11100
11101 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
11102 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
11103 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
11104
11105 The default implementation of this function returns
11106 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
11107 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
11108 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
11109 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
11110 by overriding it.
11111 @end deftypefn
11112
11113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (poly_uint64 @var{outprec}, poly_uint64 @var{inprec})
11114 This hook returns true if it is safe to ``convert'' a value of
11115 @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec} bits (where @var{outprec} is
11116 smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely operating on it as if it had only
11117 @var{outprec} bits. The default returns true unconditionally, which
11118 is correct for most machines.
11119
11120 If @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P} returns false for a pair of modes,
11121 suboptimal code can result if this hook returns true for the corresponding
11122 mode sizes. Making this hook return false in such cases may improve things.
11123 @end deftypefn
11124
11125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, scalar_int_mode @var{rep_mode})
11126 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
11127 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
11128 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
11129 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
11130 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
11131 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
11132 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
11133 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
11134 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
11135 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
11136
11137 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
11138 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
11139 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
11140 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false.
11141
11142 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
11143 describe two related properties. If you define
11144 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
11145 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
11146 extension.
11147
11148 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
11149 @code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
11150 @code{mode}.
11151 @end deftypefn
11152
11153 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SETJMP_PRESERVES_NONVOLATILE_REGS_P (void)
11154 On some targets, it is assumed that the compiler will spill all pseudos
11155 that are live across a call to @code{setjmp}, while other targets treat
11156 @code{setjmp} calls as normal function calls.
11157
11158 This hook returns false if @code{setjmp} calls do not preserve all
11159 non-volatile registers so that gcc that must spill all pseudos that are
11160 live across @code{setjmp} calls. Define this to return true if the
11161 target does not need to spill all pseudos live across @code{setjmp} calls.
11162 The default implementation conservatively assumes all pseudos must be
11163 spilled across @code{setjmp} calls.
11164 @end deftypefn
11165
11166 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
11167 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
11168 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
11169 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
11170 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
11171 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
11172
11173 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
11174 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
11175 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
11176 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
11177 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
11178 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
11179 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
11180 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
11181 the compiler.
11182
11183 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
11184 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
11185 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
11186 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
11187 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
11188 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
11189 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
11190 expression
11191
11192 @smallexample
11193 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
11194 @end smallexample
11195
11196 @noindent
11197 can be converted to
11198
11199 @smallexample
11200 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
11201 @end smallexample
11202
11203 @noindent
11204 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
11205 tested into the sign bit.
11206
11207 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
11208 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
11209 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
11210 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
11211 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
11212 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
11213
11214 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
11215 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
11216 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
11217 to be used:
11218
11219 @itemize @bullet
11220 @item
11221 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
11222 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
11223 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
11224 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
11225 combine the normalization with other operations.
11226
11227 @item
11228 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
11229 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
11230 other machines.
11231
11232 @item
11233 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
11234 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
11235 others.
11236
11237 @item
11238 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
11239 @end itemize
11240
11241 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
11242 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
11243 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
11244 those cases, e.g., one matching
11245
11246 @smallexample
11247 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
11248 @end smallexample
11249
11250 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
11251 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
11252 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
11253 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
11254 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
11255 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
11256 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
11257 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
11258
11259 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
11260 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
11261 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
11262 @end defmac
11263
11264 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11265 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
11266 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
11267 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
11268 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
11269 this macro.
11270 @end defmac
11271
11272 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11273 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
11274 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
11275 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
11276 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
11277 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
11278 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
11279 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
11280 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
11281 given mode.
11282 @end defmac
11283
11284 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11285 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11286 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
11287 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
11288 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
11289 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
11290 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
11291 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
11292 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
11293 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
11294 this value.
11295
11296 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
11297 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
11298
11299 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
11300 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
11301 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
11302 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
11303
11304 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
11305 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
11306 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
11307 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
11308 breaking the API@.
11309 @end defmac
11310
11311 @defmac Pmode
11312 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
11313 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
11314 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
11315 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
11316 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
11317
11318 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
11319 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
11320 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
11321 to @code{Pmode}.
11322 @end defmac
11323
11324 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
11325 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
11326 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
11327 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
11328 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
11329 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
11330 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
11331 @end defmac
11332
11333 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
11334 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
11335 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
11336 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
11337 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
11338 strict conformance to the C Standard.
11339
11340 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
11341 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
11342 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
11343 @end defmac
11344
11345 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
11346 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
11347
11348 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
11349 @end deftypefn
11350
11351 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
11352 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
11353 @end deftypefn
11354
11355 @defmac SYSTEM_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
11356 Define this macro if the system header files do not support C++@.
11357 This macro handles system header files by pretending that system
11358 header files are enclosed in @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
11359 @end defmac
11360
11361 @findex #pragma
11362 @findex pragma
11363 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
11364 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
11365 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
11366 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11367 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
11368 setup required for the pragmas.
11369
11370 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11371 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
11372 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
11373
11374 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
11375 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
11376
11377 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
11378 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
11379 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
11380 @end defmac
11381
11382 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11383 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11384
11385 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11386 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
11387 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11388 pragma of the form
11389
11390 @smallexample
11391 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11392 @end smallexample
11393
11394 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11395 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11396 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11397 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
11398 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
11399 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
11400 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11401 arguments of pragmas registered with
11402 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11403 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11404
11405 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11406 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11407 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11408 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11409 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
11410 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11411 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
11412 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11413 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
11414 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11415 how to build this object file.
11416 @end deftypefun
11417
11418 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11419 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11420 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11421 @end defmac
11422
11423 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11424 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11425 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11426 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11427 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11428 @end defmac
11429
11430 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11431 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11432 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
11433 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11434 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11435 @end defmac
11436
11437 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11438 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11439 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11440 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11441 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11442 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11443 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11444 you should define this macro.
11445
11446 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11447 @end defmac
11448
11449 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11450 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11451 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11452 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11453 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11454 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11455 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11456 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11457 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11458 slot of @var{insn}.
11459
11460 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11461 @end defmac
11462
11463 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11464 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11465 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11466 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11467 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11468 from shared libraries (DLLs).
11469
11470 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11471 @end defmac
11472
11473 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11474 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11475 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11476 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11477 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11478
11479 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11480 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11481 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11482 @end deftypefn
11483
11484 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11485 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11486 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11487 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
11488 separate math library.
11489
11490 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11491 @end defmac
11492
11493 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11494 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11495 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11496
11497 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11498 is wrong.
11499 @end defmac
11500
11501 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11502 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11503 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11504 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11505 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11506 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11507 for cross-profiling.
11508 @end defmac
11509
11510 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11511
11512 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11513 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11514 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11515 1 if it does use cc0.
11516 @end defmac
11517
11518 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11519 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11520 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11521 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11522 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11523 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11524 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11525 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11526 @end defmac
11527
11528 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11529 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11530 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11531 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11532 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11533 @end defmac
11534
11535 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11536 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11537 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11538 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11539 about the currently processed blocks.
11540 @end defmac
11541
11542 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11543 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11544 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11545 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11546 to by @var{ce_info}.
11547 @end defmac
11548
11549 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11550 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11551 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11552 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11553 to by @var{ce_info}.
11554 @end defmac
11555
11556 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11557 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11558 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11559 to by @var{ce_info}.
11560 @end defmac
11561
11562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11563 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11564 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11565 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11566
11567 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11568 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11569 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11570 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11571
11572 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11573 definition is null.
11574 @end deftypefn
11575
11576 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11577 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11578 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11579 necessary setup.
11580
11581 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11582 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11583 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11584 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11585
11586 To create a built-in function, call the function
11587 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11588 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11589 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11590 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11591 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11592 @end deftypefn
11593
11594 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11595 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11596 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11597 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11598 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11599 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11600 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11601 @code{error_mark_node}.
11602 @end deftypefn
11603
11604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11605
11606 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11607 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11608 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11609 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11610 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11611 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11612 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11613 built-in function.
11614 @end deftypefn
11615
11616 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11617 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11618 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11619 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11620 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11621 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11622 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11623 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11624 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11625 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11626 @end deftypefn
11627
11628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CHECK_BUILTIN_CALL (location_t @var{loc}, vec<location_t> @var{arg_loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{orig_fndecl}, unsigned int @var{nargs}, tree *@var{args})
11629 Perform semantic checking on a call to a machine-specific built-in
11630 function after its arguments have been constrained to the function
11631 signature. Return true if the call is valid, otherwise report an error
11632 and return false.
11633
11634 This hook is called after @code{TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN}.
11635 The call was originally to built-in function @var{orig_fndecl},
11636 but after the optional @code{TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN}
11637 step is now to built-in function @var{fndecl}. @var{loc} is the
11638 location of the call and @var{args} is an array of function arguments,
11639 of which there are @var{nargs}. @var{arg_loc} specifies the location
11640 of each argument.
11641 @end deftypefn
11642
11643 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11644 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11645 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11646 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11647 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11648 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11649 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11650 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11651 @end deftypefn
11652
11653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11654 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11655 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11656 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11657 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11658 @end deftypefn
11659
11660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11661 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11662 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11663 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11664 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11665 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11666 the two function decls that will be compared.
11667 @end deftypefn
11668
11669 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11670 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11671 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11672 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11673 identical versions.
11674 @end deftypefn
11675
11676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11677 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11678 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11679 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11680 body must be generated.
11681 @end deftypefn
11682
11683 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PREDICT_DOLOOP_P (class loop *@var{loop})
11684 Return true if we can predict it is possible to use a low-overhead loop
11685 for a particular loop. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to the loop.
11686 This target hook is required only when the target supports low-overhead
11687 loops, and will help ivopts to make some decisions.
11688 The default version of this hook returns false.
11689 @end deftypefn
11690
11691 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_COUNT_REG_DECR_P
11692 Return true if the target supports hardware count register for decrement
11693 and branch.
11694 The default value is false.
11695 @end deftypevr
11696
11697 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int64_t TARGET_DOLOOP_COST_FOR_GENERIC
11698 One IV candidate dedicated for doloop is introduced in IVOPTs, we can
11699 calculate the computation cost of adopting it to any generic IV use by
11700 function get_computation_cost as before. But for targets which have
11701 hardware count register support for decrement and branch, it may have to
11702 move IV value from hardware count register to general purpose register
11703 while doloop IV candidate is used for generic IV uses. It probably takes
11704 expensive penalty. This hook allows target owners to define the cost for
11705 this especially for generic IV uses.
11706 The default value is zero.
11707 @end deftypevr
11708
11709 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int64_t TARGET_DOLOOP_COST_FOR_ADDRESS
11710 One IV candidate dedicated for doloop is introduced in IVOPTs, we can
11711 calculate the computation cost of adopting it to any address IV use by
11712 function get_computation_cost as before. But for targets which have
11713 hardware count register support for decrement and branch, it may have to
11714 move IV value from hardware count register to general purpose register
11715 while doloop IV candidate is used for address IV uses. It probably takes
11716 expensive penalty. This hook allows target owners to define the cost for
11717 this escpecially for address IV uses.
11718 The default value is zero.
11719 @end deftypevr
11720
11721 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11722 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11723 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11724 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11725 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11726 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11727 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11728 loop is only entered from the top.
11729
11730 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11731 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11732 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11733 @end deftypefn
11734
11735 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11736
11737 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11738 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11739 could not be applied.
11740
11741 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11742 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11743 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11744 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11745 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11746 @end deftypefn
11747
11748 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11749 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11750 @end deftypefn
11751
11752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11753 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11754 @end deftypefn
11755
11756 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11757 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11758 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11759 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11760 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11761 @end deftypefn
11762
11763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11764
11765 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11766 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11767 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11768 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11769 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11770 that had its initial value copied by using
11771 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11772 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11773 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11774 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11775 @code{MEM}.
11776 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11777 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11778 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11779 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11780 register in question will not be clobbered.
11781 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11782 allocation.
11783 @end deftypefn
11784
11785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11786 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11787 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11788 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11789 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11790 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11791 passed along.
11792 @end deftypefn
11793
11794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11795 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11796 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11797 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11798 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11799 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11800 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11801 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11802 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11803 The default hook function does nothing.
11804
11805 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11806 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11807 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11808 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11809 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11810 outside of any function scope.
11811 @end deftypefn
11812
11813 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11814 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11815 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11816 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11817 @end defmac
11818
11819 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11820 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11821 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11822 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11823 executable files.
11824 @end defmac
11825
11826 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11827 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11828 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11829 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11830 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11831 lists.
11832 @end defmac
11833
11834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11835 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11836 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11837 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11838 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11839
11840 @smallexample
11841 static bool
11842 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11843 @{
11844 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11845 @}
11846 @end smallexample
11847 @end deftypefn
11848
11849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11850 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11851 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11852 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11853 @end deftypefn
11854
11855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11856 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11857 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11858 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11859 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11860 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11861 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11862 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11863 @end deftypefn
11864
11865 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11866 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11867 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11868 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11869 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11870 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11871 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11872 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11873 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11874 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11875 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11876 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11877 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11878 @end deftypefn
11879
11880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, class loop *@var{loop})
11881 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11882 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11883 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11884 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11885 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11886 number of memory accesses.
11887 @end deftypefn
11888
11889 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11890 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11891 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11892 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11893 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11894 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11895 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11896 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11897 @end defmac
11898
11899 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11900 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11901 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11902 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11903 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11904 @end deftypefn
11905
11906 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11907 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11908 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11909 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11910 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11911 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11912 @end deftypefn
11913
11914 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11915 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11916 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11917 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11918 that are different from @option{-I}.
11919 @end deftypefn
11920
11921 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11922 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11923 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11924 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11925 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11926 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11927 @end defmac
11928
11929 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11930 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11931 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11932 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11933 @end defmac
11934
11935 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11936 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11937 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11938 @end defmac
11939
11940 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11941 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11942 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11943 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11944 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11945 @end defmac
11946
11947 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11948 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11949 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11950 @end defmac
11951
11952 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11953 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11954 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11955 and scanf formatter settings.
11956 @end defmac
11957
11958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11959 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11960 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11961 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11962 @end deftypefn
11963
11964 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11965 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11966 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11967 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11968 @end deftypefn
11969
11970 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11971 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11972 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11973 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11974 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11975 @end deftypefn
11976
11977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11978 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11979 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11980 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11981 the front end.
11982 @end deftypefn
11983
11984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11985 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11986 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11987 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11988 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11989 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11990 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11991 @end deftypefn
11992
11993 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11994 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11995 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11996 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11997 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11998 conversion rules.
11999 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
12000 @end deftypefn
12001
12002 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VERIFY_TYPE_CONTEXT (location_t @var{loc}, type_context_kind @var{context}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{silent_p})
12003 If defined, this hook returns false if there is a target-specific reason
12004 why type @var{type} cannot be used in the source language context described
12005 by @var{context}. When @var{silent_p} is false, the hook also reports an
12006 error against @var{loc} for invalid uses of @var{type}.
12007
12008 Calls to this hook should be made through the global function
12009 @code{verify_type_context}, which makes the @var{silent_p} parameter
12010 default to false and also handles @code{error_mark_node}.
12011
12012 The default implementation always returns true.
12013 @end deftypefn
12014
12015 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
12016 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
12017 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
12018 @end defmac
12019
12020 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
12021 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
12022 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
12023 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
12024 and the associated definitions of those functions.
12025 @end defmac
12026
12027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
12028 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
12029 necessary.
12030 @end deftypefn
12031
12032 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
12033 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
12034 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
12035 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
12036 is needed.
12037 @end deftypefn
12038
12039 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
12040 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
12041 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
12042 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
12043 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
12044 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
12045 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
12046 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
12047 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
12048 @end deftypefn
12049
12050 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
12051 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
12052 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
12053 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
12054 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
12055 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
12056 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
12057 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
12058 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
12059 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
12060 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
12061 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
12062 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
12063 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
12064 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
12065 is zero, which disables this optimization.
12066 @end deftypevr
12067
12068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
12069 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
12070 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
12071 supported by the target.
12072 @end deftypefn
12073
12074 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
12075 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
12076 memory model bits are allowed.
12077 @end deftypefn
12078
12079 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
12080 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e.@: the @code{bool} @code{true}.
12081 @end deftypevr
12082
12083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
12084 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
12085 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
12086 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
12087 @end deftypefn
12088
12089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
12090 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
12091 @end deftypefn
12092
12093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
12094 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
12095 @end deftypefn
12096
12097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
12098 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
12099 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
12100 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
12101 @end deftypefn
12102
12103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
12104 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
12105 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
12106 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
12107 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
12108 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
12109
12110 @end deftypefn
12111
12112 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
12113
12114 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
12115 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
12116 to indicate that large integers are stored in
12117 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
12118 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
12119 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
12120 representation.
12121
12122 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
12123 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
12124 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
12125 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
12126 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
12127
12128 @itemize @bullet
12129 @item
12130 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
12131 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
12132 language since there are a variable number of elements.
12133
12134 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
12135 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
12136 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
12137 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
12138 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
12139 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
12140 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
12141 not really a large change.
12142
12143 @item
12144 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
12145 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
12146 port in this code.
12147
12148 @item
12149 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
12150 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
12151 @end itemize
12152
12153 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
12154 maintainer is familiar with.
12155
12156 @end defmac
12157
12158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (bool @var{active})
12159 This hook is used to determine the level of target support for
12160 @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}. If called with an argument
12161 of false, it returns true if the target has been modified to support
12162 this builtin. If called with an argument of true, it returns true
12163 if the target requires active mitigation execution might be speculative.
12164
12165 The default implementation returns false if the target does not define
12166 a pattern named @code{speculation_barrier}. Else it returns true
12167 for the first case and whether the pattern is enabled for the current
12168 compilation for the second case.
12169
12170 For targets that have no processors that can execute instructions
12171 speculatively an alternative implemenation of this hook is available:
12172 simply redefine this hook to @code{speculation_safe_value_not_needed}
12173 along with your other target hooks.
12174 @end deftypefn
12175
12176 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{result}, rtx @var{val}, rtx @var{failval})
12177 This target hook can be used to generate a target-specific code
12178 sequence that implements the @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}
12179 built-in function. The function must always return @var{val} in
12180 @var{result} in mode @var{mode} when the cpu is not executing
12181 speculatively, but must never return that when speculating until it
12182 is known that the speculation will not be unwound. The hook supports
12183 two primary mechanisms for implementing the requirements. The first
12184 is to emit a speculation barrier which forces the processor to wait
12185 until all prior speculative operations have been resolved; the second
12186 is to use a target-specific mechanism that can track the speculation
12187 state and to return @var{failval} if it can determine that
12188 speculation must be unwound at a later time.
12189
12190 The default implementation simply copies @var{val} to @var{result} and
12191 emits a @code{speculation_barrier} instruction if that is defined.
12192 @end deftypefn
12193
12194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
12195 If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
12196 @end deftypefn